]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
(x_term_init) [!USE_XIM]: Use `useXIM' resource to turn on XIM.
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000, 01, 02, 2003
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
135 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
138 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
139 #ifndef XtNpickTop
140 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
141 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
142 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
143 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144
145 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146
147 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
148 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #endif
151
152 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
153 #include "widget.h"
154 #ifndef XtNinitialState
155 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
156 #endif
157 #endif
158
159 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160
161 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
162 #ifdef USE_XIM
163 int use_xim = 1;
164 #else
165 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
166 #endif
167
168 \f
169
170 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
171
172 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
173
174 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
175 start. */
176
177 static int any_help_event_p;
178
179 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
180 static Lisp_Object last_window;
181
182 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
183
184 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
185
186 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
187 use. */
188
189 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
190
191 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
192 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
193 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
194 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
195
196 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
197
198 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
199 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
200 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
201 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
202
203 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
204
205 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
206
207 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
208
209 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
210 /* The application context for Xt use. */
211 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
212 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
213 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
214
215 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
216
217 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
218
219 /* Mouse movement.
220
221 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
222 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
223 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
224 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
225
226 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
227
228 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
229 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
230 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
231 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
232 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
233 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
234 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
235 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
236 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
237 is off. */
238
239 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
240
241 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
242 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
243
244 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
245
246 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
247 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
248 an ordinary motion.
249
250 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
251 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
252 event. */
253
254 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
255
256 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
257 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
258 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
259 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
260 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
261 it's somewhat accurate. */
262
263 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
264
265 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
266 events. */
267
268 #ifdef __STDC__
269 static int volatile input_signal_count;
270 #else
271 static int input_signal_count;
272 #endif
273
274 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
275
276 static int x_noop_count;
277
278 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
279
280 extern char **initial_argv;
281 extern int initial_argc;
282
283 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
284
285 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
286
287 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
288
289 extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face, Qeql;
290
291 extern int errno;
292
293 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
294
295 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
296
297 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
298
299 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
300 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
301 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
302
303 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
304 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
305
306 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
307
308
309 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
310 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
311 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
312 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
313 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
314 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
315 unsigned));
316 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
317 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
318 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
319 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
320 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
321 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
322 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
323 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
324 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
325 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
326 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
327 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
328 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
329 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
330 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
331 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
332 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
333 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
334 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
335 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
336 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
337 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
338 static int x_focus_changed P_ ((int,
339 int,
340 struct x_display_info *,
341 struct frame *,
342 struct input_event *,
343 int));
344 static int x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
345 XEvent *,
346 struct input_event *,
347 int));
348 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
350 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
351 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
352 enum text_cursor_kinds));
353
354 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
355 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
356 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
357 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
358 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
359 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Window));
360 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
361 enum scroll_bar_part *,
362 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
363 unsigned long *));
364 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
365 static void x_check_fullscreen_move P_ ((struct frame *));
366 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
367 XEvent *,
368 struct input_event **,
369 int *,
370 int *));
371
372
373 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
374
375 static void
376 x_flush (f)
377 struct frame *f;
378 {
379 BLOCK_INPUT;
380 if (f == NULL)
381 {
382 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
383 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
384 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
385 }
386 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
387 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
388 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
389 }
390
391
392 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
393 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
394 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
395 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
396 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
397 performance. */
398
399 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
400
401 \f
402 /***********************************************************************
403 Debugging
404 ***********************************************************************/
405
406 #if 0
407
408 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
409 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
410
411 struct record
412 {
413 char *locus;
414 int type;
415 };
416
417 struct record event_record[100];
418
419 int event_record_index;
420
421 record_event (locus, type)
422 char *locus;
423 int type;
424 {
425 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
426 event_record_index = 0;
427
428 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
429 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
430 event_record_index++;
431 }
432
433 #endif /* 0 */
434
435
436 \f
437 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
438
439 struct x_display_info *
440 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
441 Display *dpy;
442 {
443 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
444
445 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
446 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
447 return dpyinfo;
448
449 return 0;
450 }
451
452
453 \f
454 /***********************************************************************
455 Starting and ending an update
456 ***********************************************************************/
457
458 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
459 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
460 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
461 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
462 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
463
464 static void
465 x_update_begin (f)
466 struct frame *f;
467 {
468 /* Nothing to do. */
469 }
470
471
472 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
473 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
474 position of W. */
475
476 static void
477 x_update_window_begin (w)
478 struct window *w;
479 {
480 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
481 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
482
483 updated_window = w;
484 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
485
486 BLOCK_INPUT;
487
488 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
489 {
490 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
491 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
492
493 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
494 highlighting. */
495 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
496 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
497
498 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
499 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
500 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
501 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
502 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
503 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
504
505 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
506 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
507 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
508 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
509 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
510 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
511 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
512 {
513 int i;
514
515 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
516 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
517 break;
518
519 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
520 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
521 }
522 #endif /* 0 */
523 }
524
525 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
526 }
527
528
529 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
530
531 static void
532 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
533 struct window *w;
534 int x, y0, y1;
535 {
536 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
537
538 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
539 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
540 }
541
542 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
543
544 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
545 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
546
547 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
548 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
549 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
550
551 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
552 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
553 here. */
554
555 static void
556 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
557 struct window *w;
558 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
559 {
560 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
561
562 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
563 {
564 BLOCK_INPUT;
565
566 if (cursor_on_p)
567 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
568 output_cursor.vpos,
569 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
570
571 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
572 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
573 }
574
575 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
576 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
577 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
578 {
579 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
580 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
581 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
582 }
583
584 updated_window = NULL;
585 }
586
587
588 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
589 update_end. */
590
591 static void
592 x_update_end (f)
593 struct frame *f;
594 {
595 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
596 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
597
598 #ifndef XFlush
599 BLOCK_INPUT;
600 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
601 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
602 #endif
603 }
604
605
606 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
607 complete update has been performed. The global variable
608 updated_window is not available here. */
609
610 static void
611 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
612 struct frame *f;
613 {
614 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
615 {
616 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
617
618 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
619 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
620 {
621 BLOCK_INPUT;
622 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
623 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
624 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
625 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
626 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
627 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
628 }
629 }
630 }
631
632
633 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
634 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
635 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
636 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
637 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
638 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
639
640 static void
641 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
642 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
643 {
644 struct window *w = updated_window;
645 struct frame *f;
646 int width, height;
647
648 xassert (w);
649
650 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
651 {
652 BLOCK_INPUT;
653 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
654 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
655 }
656
657 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
658 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
659 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
660 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
661 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
662 overhead is very small. */
663 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
664 && desired_row->full_width_p
665 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
666 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
667 width != 0)
668 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
669 height > 0))
670 {
671 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
672
673 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
674 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
675 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
676 y -= width;
677
678 BLOCK_INPUT;
679 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
680 0, y, width, height, False);
681 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
682 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
683 y, width, height, False);
684 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
685 }
686 }
687
688 static void
689 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
690 struct window *w;
691 struct glyph_row *row;
692 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
693 {
694 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
695 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
696 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
697 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
698 struct face *face = p->face;
699
700 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
701 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
702
703 if (p->bx >= 0)
704 {
705 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
706 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
707 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
708 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
709 if (face->stipple)
710 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
711 else
712 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
713
714 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
715 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
716
717 if (!face->stipple)
718 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
719 }
720
721 if (p->which != NO_FRINGE_BITMAP)
722 {
723 unsigned char *bits = fringe_bitmaps[p->which].bits + p->dh;
724 Pixmap pixmap;
725 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
726
727 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
728 by the server. */
729 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
730 face->foreground,
731 face->background, depth);
732 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
733 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
734 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
735 }
736
737 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
738 }
739
740 \f
741
742 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
743 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
744 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
745 rarely happens). */
746
747 static void
748 XTset_terminal_modes ()
749 {
750 }
751
752 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
753 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
754
755 static void
756 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
757 {
758 }
759
760
761 \f
762 /***********************************************************************
763 Display Iterator
764 ***********************************************************************/
765
766 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
767
768 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
769
770
771 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
772 is not contained in the font. */
773
774 static XCharStruct *
775 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
776 XFontStruct *font;
777 XChar2b *char2b;
778 int font_type; /* unused on X */
779 {
780 /* The result metric information. */
781 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
782
783 xassert (font && char2b);
784
785 if (font->per_char != NULL)
786 {
787 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
788 {
789 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
790 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
791 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
792 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
793 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
794 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
795 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
796 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
797 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
798 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
799 }
800 else
801 {
802 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
803 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
804 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
805 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
806
807 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
808 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
809
810 where:
811
812 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
813 / = integer division
814 \ = integer modulus */
815 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
816 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
817 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
818 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
819 {
820 pcm = (font->per_char
821 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
822 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
823 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
824 }
825 }
826 }
827 else
828 {
829 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
830 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
831 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
832 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
833 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
834 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
835 }
836
837 return ((pcm == NULL
838 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
839 ? NULL : pcm);
840 }
841
842
843 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
844 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
845
846 static int
847 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
848 int c;
849 XChar2b *char2b;
850 struct font_info *font_info;
851 int *two_byte_p;
852 {
853 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
854 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
855
856 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
857 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
858 fixed encoding. */
859 if (font_info->font_encoder)
860 {
861 /* It's a program. */
862 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
863
864 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
865 {
866 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
867 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
868 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
869 }
870 else
871 {
872 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
873 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
874 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
875 }
876
877 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
878
879 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
880 program. */
881 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
882 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
883 else
884 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
885 }
886 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
887 {
888 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
889 encoding numbers. */
890 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
891
892 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
893 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
894 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
895
896 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
897 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
898 }
899
900 if (two_byte_p)
901 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
902
903 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
904 }
905
906
907 \f
908 /***********************************************************************
909 Glyph display
910 ***********************************************************************/
911
912
913
914 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
915 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
916 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
917 int));
918 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
919 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
920 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
921 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
922 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
923 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
924 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
925 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
926 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
927 unsigned long *, double, int));
928 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
929 double, int, unsigned long));
930 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
931 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
932 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
933 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
934 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
935 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
936 int, int, int));
937 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
938 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
939 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
940 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
941
942 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
943 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
944 #endif
945
946
947 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
948 face. */
949
950 static void
951 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
952 struct glyph_string *s;
953 {
954 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
955 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
956 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
957 && !s->cmp)
958 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
959 else
960 {
961 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
962 XGCValues xgcv;
963 unsigned long mask;
964
965 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
966 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
967
968 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
969 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
970 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
971 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
972 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
973 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
974 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
975
976 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
977 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
978 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
979 {
980 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
981 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
982 }
983
984 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
985 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
986 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
987 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
988
989 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
990 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
991 mask, &xgcv);
992 else
993 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
994 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
995
996 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
997 }
998 }
999
1000
1001 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1002
1003 static void
1004 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1005 struct glyph_string *s;
1006 {
1007 int face_id;
1008 struct face *face;
1009
1010 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1011 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1012 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1013 if (face == NULL)
1014 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1015
1016 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1017 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1018 else
1019 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1020 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1021 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1022
1023 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1024 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1025 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1026 else
1027 {
1028 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1029 but font FONT. */
1030 XGCValues xgcv;
1031 unsigned long mask;
1032
1033 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1034 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1039
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1046
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1048 }
1049
1050 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1051 }
1052
1053
1054 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1055 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1056 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1057
1058 static INLINE void
1059 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1060 struct glyph_string *s;
1061 {
1062 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1063 }
1064
1065
1066 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1067 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1068 pattern. */
1069
1070 static INLINE void
1071 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1072 struct glyph_string *s;
1073 {
1074 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1075
1076 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1077 {
1078 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1079 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1080 }
1081 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1082 {
1083 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1084 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1085 }
1086 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1087 {
1088 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1089 s->stippled_p = 0;
1090 }
1091 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1092 {
1093 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1094 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1095 }
1096 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1097 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1098 {
1099 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1100 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1101 }
1102 else
1103 {
1104 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1105 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1106 }
1107
1108 /* GC must have been set. */
1109 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1110 }
1111
1112
1113 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1114 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1115
1116 static INLINE void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1118 struct glyph_string *s;
1119 {
1120 XRectangle r;
1121 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1122 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1123 }
1124
1125
1126 /* RIF:
1127 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1128 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1129
1130 static void
1131 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1132 struct glyph_string *s;
1133 {
1134 if (s->cmp == NULL
1135 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1136 {
1137 XCharStruct cs;
1138 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1139 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1140 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1141 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1142 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1143 }
1144 }
1145
1146
1147 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1148
1149 static INLINE void
1150 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1151 struct glyph_string *s;
1152 int x, y, w, h;
1153 {
1154 XGCValues xgcv;
1155 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1156 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1157 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1158 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1159 }
1160
1161
1162 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1163 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1164 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1165 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1166 contains the first component of a composition. */
1167
1168 static void
1169 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1170 struct glyph_string *s;
1171 int force_p;
1172 {
1173 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1174 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1175 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1176 {
1177 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1178
1179 if (s->stippled_p)
1180 {
1181 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1182 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1183 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1184 s->y + box_line_width,
1185 s->background_width,
1186 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1187 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1188 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1189 }
1190 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1191 || s->font_not_found_p
1192 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1193 || force_p)
1194 {
1195 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1196 s->background_width,
1197 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1198 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1199 }
1200 }
1201 }
1202
1203
1204 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1205
1206 static void
1207 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1208 struct glyph_string *s;
1209 {
1210 int i, x;
1211
1212 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1213 of S to the right of that box line. */
1214 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1215 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1216 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1217 else
1218 x = s->x;
1219
1220 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1221 loaded. */
1222 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1223 {
1224 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1225 {
1226 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1227 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1228 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1229 s->height - 1);
1230 x += g->pixel_width;
1231 }
1232 }
1233 else
1234 {
1235 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1236 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1237
1238 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1239 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1240
1241 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1242 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1243 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1244 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1245
1246 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1247 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1248 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1249 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1250 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1251 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1252 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1253 {
1254 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1255 if (s->two_byte_p)
1256 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1257 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1258 else
1259 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1260 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1261 }
1262 else
1263 {
1264 if (s->two_byte_p)
1265 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1266 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1267 else
1268 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1269 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1270 }
1271
1272 if (s->face->overstrike)
1273 {
1274 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1275 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1276 if (s->two_byte_p)
1277 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1278 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1279 else
1280 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1281 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1282 }
1283 }
1284 }
1285
1286 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1287
1288 static void
1289 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1290 struct glyph_string *s;
1291 {
1292 int i, x;
1293
1294 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1295 of S to the right of that box line. */
1296 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1297 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1298 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1299 else
1300 x = s->x;
1301
1302 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1303 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1304 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1305 this composition. */
1306
1307 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1308 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1309 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1310 {
1311 if (s->gidx == 0)
1312 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1313 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1314 }
1315 else
1316 {
1317 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1318 {
1319 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1320 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1321 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1322 s->char2b + i, 1);
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1325 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1326 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1327 s->char2b + i, 1);
1328 }
1329 }
1330 }
1331
1332
1333 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1334
1335 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1336 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1337 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1338 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1339 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1340
1341
1342 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1343 cannot be determined. */
1344
1345 static struct frame *
1346 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1347 Widget widget;
1348 {
1349 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1350 Lisp_Object tail;
1351 struct frame *f;
1352
1353 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1354
1355 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1356 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1357 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1358 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1359 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1360 widget = XtParent (widget);
1361
1362 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1363 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1364 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1365 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1366 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1367 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1368 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1369 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1370 return f;
1371
1372 abort ();
1373 }
1374
1375
1376 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1377 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1378 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1379 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1380
1381 int
1382 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1383 Widget widget;
1384 Colormap cmap;
1385 XColor *color;
1386 {
1387 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1388 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1389 }
1390
1391
1392 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1393 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1394 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1395 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1396 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1397 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1398
1399 int
1400 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1401 Widget widget;
1402 Display *display;
1403 Colormap cmap;
1404 unsigned long *pixel;
1405 double factor;
1406 int delta;
1407 {
1408 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1409 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1410 }
1411
1412
1413 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1414 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1415
1416 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1417 {
1418 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1419 sizeof (Screen *)},
1420 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1421 sizeof (Colormap)}
1422 };
1423
1424
1425 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1426 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1427
1428 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1429
1430
1431 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1432
1433 DPY is the display we are working on.
1434
1435 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1436 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1437 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1438 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1439
1440 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1441 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1442
1443 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1444 we allocated the color or not.
1445
1446 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1447
1448 static Boolean
1449 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1450 Display *dpy;
1451 XrmValue *args;
1452 Cardinal *nargs;
1453 XrmValue *from, *to;
1454 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1455 {
1456 Screen *screen;
1457 Colormap cmap;
1458 Pixel pixel;
1459 String color_name;
1460 XColor color;
1461
1462 if (*nargs != 2)
1463 {
1464 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1465 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1466 "XtToolkitError",
1467 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1468 return False;
1469 }
1470
1471 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1472 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1473 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1474
1475 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1476 {
1477 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1478 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1479 }
1480 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1481 {
1482 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1483 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1484 }
1485 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1486 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1487 {
1488 pixel = color.pixel;
1489 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1490 }
1491 else
1492 {
1493 String params[1];
1494 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1495
1496 params[0] = color_name;
1497 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1498 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1499 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1500 params, &nparams);
1501 return False;
1502 }
1503
1504 if (to->addr != NULL)
1505 {
1506 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1507 {
1508 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1509 return False;
1510 }
1511
1512 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1513 }
1514 else
1515 {
1516 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1517 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1518 }
1519
1520 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1521 return True;
1522 }
1523
1524
1525 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1526 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1527 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1528
1529 APP is the application context in which we work.
1530
1531 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1532 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1533 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1534
1535 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1536
1537 static void
1538 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1539 XtAppContext app;
1540 XrmValuePtr to;
1541 XtPointer closure;
1542 XrmValuePtr args;
1543 Cardinal *nargs;
1544 {
1545 if (*nargs != 2)
1546 {
1547 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1548 "XtToolkitError",
1549 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1550 NULL, NULL);
1551 }
1552 else if (closure != NULL)
1553 {
1554 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1555 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1556 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1557 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1558 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1559 }
1560 }
1561
1562
1563 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1564
1565
1566 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1567 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1568 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1569 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1570
1571 static const XColor *
1572 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1573 Display *dpy;
1574 int *ncells;
1575 {
1576 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1577
1578 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1579 {
1580 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1581 int i;
1582
1583 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1584 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1585 dpyinfo->color_cells
1586 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1587 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1588
1589 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1590 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1591
1592 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1593 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1594 }
1595
1596 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1597 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1598 }
1599
1600
1601 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1602 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1603
1604 void
1605 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1606 struct frame *f;
1607 XColor *colors;
1608 int ncolors;
1609 {
1610 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1611
1612 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1613 {
1614 int i;
1615 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1616 {
1617 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1618 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1619 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1620 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1621 }
1622 }
1623 else
1624 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1625 }
1626
1627
1628 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1629 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1630
1631 void
1632 x_query_color (f, color)
1633 struct frame *f;
1634 XColor *color;
1635 {
1636 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1637 }
1638
1639
1640 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1641 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1642 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1643 allocated. */
1644
1645 static int
1646 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1647 Display *dpy;
1648 Colormap cmap;
1649 XColor *color;
1650 {
1651 int rc;
1652
1653 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1654 if (rc == 0)
1655 {
1656 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1657 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1658 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1659 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1660 int nearest, i;
1661 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1662 int ncells;
1663 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1664
1665 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1666 {
1667 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1668 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1669 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1670 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1671
1672 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1673 {
1674 nearest = i;
1675 nearest_delta = delta;
1676 }
1677 }
1678
1679 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1680 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1681 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1682 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1683 }
1684 else
1685 {
1686 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1687 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1688 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1689 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1690 XColor *cached_color;
1691
1692 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1693 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1694 (cached_color->red != color->red
1695 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1696 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1697 {
1698 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1699 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1700 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1701 }
1702 }
1703
1704 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1705 if (rc)
1706 register_color (color->pixel);
1707 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1708
1709 return rc;
1710 }
1711
1712
1713 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1714 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1715 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1716 allocated. */
1717
1718 int
1719 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1720 struct frame *f;
1721 Colormap cmap;
1722 XColor *color;
1723 {
1724 gamma_correct (f, color);
1725 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1726 }
1727
1728
1729 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1730 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1731 get color reference counts right. */
1732
1733 unsigned long
1734 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1735 struct frame *f;
1736 unsigned long pixel;
1737 {
1738 XColor color;
1739
1740 color.pixel = pixel;
1741 BLOCK_INPUT;
1742 x_query_color (f, &color);
1743 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1744 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1745 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1746 register_color (pixel);
1747 #endif
1748 return color.pixel;
1749 }
1750
1751
1752 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1753 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1754 get color reference counts right. */
1755
1756 unsigned long
1757 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1758 Display *dpy;
1759 Colormap cmap;
1760 unsigned long pixel;
1761 {
1762 XColor color;
1763
1764 color.pixel = pixel;
1765 BLOCK_INPUT;
1766 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1767 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1768 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1769 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1770 register_color (pixel);
1771 #endif
1772 return color.pixel;
1773 }
1774
1775
1776 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1777 boosted.
1778
1779 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1780 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1781 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1782 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1783 use an additional additive factor.
1784
1785 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1786 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1787 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1788
1789
1790 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1791 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1792 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1793 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1794 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1795 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1796
1797 static int
1798 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1799 struct frame *f;
1800 Display *display;
1801 Colormap cmap;
1802 unsigned long *pixel;
1803 double factor;
1804 int delta;
1805 {
1806 XColor color, new;
1807 long bright;
1808 int success_p;
1809
1810 /* Get RGB color values. */
1811 color.pixel = *pixel;
1812 x_query_color (f, &color);
1813
1814 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1815 xassert (factor >= 0);
1816 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1817 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1818 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1819
1820 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1821 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1822
1823 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1824 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1825 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1826 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1827 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1828 {
1829 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1830 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1831 /* The additive adjustment. */
1832 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1833
1834 if (factor < 1)
1835 {
1836 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1837 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1838 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1839 }
1840 else
1841 {
1842 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1843 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1844 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1845 }
1846 }
1847
1848 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1849 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1850 if (success_p)
1851 {
1852 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1853 {
1854 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1855 delta to the RGB values. */
1856 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1857
1858 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1859 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1860 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1861 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1862 }
1863 else
1864 success_p = 1;
1865 *pixel = new.pixel;
1866 }
1867
1868 return success_p;
1869 }
1870
1871
1872 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1873 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1874 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1875 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1876 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1877 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1878
1879 static void
1880 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1881 struct frame *f;
1882 struct relief *relief;
1883 double factor;
1884 int delta;
1885 unsigned long default_pixel;
1886 {
1887 XGCValues xgcv;
1888 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1889 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1890 unsigned long pixel;
1891 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1892 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1893 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1894 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1895
1896 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1897 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1898
1899 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1900 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1901 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1902 if (relief->gc
1903 && relief->allocated_p)
1904 {
1905 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1906 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1907 }
1908
1909 /* Allocate new color. */
1910 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1911 pixel = background;
1912 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1913 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1914 {
1915 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1916 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1917 }
1918
1919 if (relief->gc == 0)
1920 {
1921 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1922 mask |= GCStipple;
1923 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1924 }
1925 else
1926 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1927 }
1928
1929
1930 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1931
1932 static void
1933 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1934 struct glyph_string *s;
1935 {
1936 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1937 unsigned long color;
1938
1939 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1940 color = s->face->box_color;
1941 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1942 && s->img->pixmap
1943 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1944 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1945 else
1946 {
1947 XGCValues xgcv;
1948
1949 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1950 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1951 color = xgcv.background;
1952 }
1953
1954 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1955 || color != di->relief_background)
1956 {
1957 di->relief_background = color;
1958 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1959 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1960 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1961 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1962 }
1963 }
1964
1965
1966 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1967 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1968 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1969 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1970 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1971 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1972 when drawing. */
1973
1974 static void
1975 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
1976 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
1977 struct frame *f;
1978 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
1979 XRectangle *clip_rect;
1980 {
1981 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1982 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1983 int i;
1984 GC gc;
1985
1986 if (raised_p)
1987 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1988 else
1989 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1990 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1991
1992 /* Top. */
1993 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1994 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1995 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1996 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1997
1998 /* Left. */
1999 if (left_p)
2000 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2003
2004 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2005 if (raised_p)
2006 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2007 else
2008 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2009 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2010
2011 /* Bottom. */
2012 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2013 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2014 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2015 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2016
2017 /* Right. */
2018 if (right_p)
2019 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2020 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2021 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2022
2023 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2024 }
2025
2026
2027 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2028 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2029 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2030 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2031 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2032 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2033
2034 static void
2035 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2036 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2037 struct glyph_string *s;
2038 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2039 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2040 {
2041 XGCValues xgcv;
2042
2043 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2044 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2045 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2046
2047 /* Top. */
2048 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2049 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2050
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2054 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2055
2056 /* Bottom. */
2057 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2058 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2059
2060 /* Right. */
2061 if (right_p)
2062 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2063 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2064
2065 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2066 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2067 }
2068
2069
2070 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2071
2072 static void
2073 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2074 struct glyph_string *s;
2075 {
2076 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2077 int left_p, right_p;
2078 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2079 XRectangle clip_rect;
2080
2081 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2082 if (s->row->full_width_p
2083 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2084 {
2085 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2086 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2087 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2088 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2089 }
2090
2091 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2092 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2093 ? s->first_glyph
2094 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2095
2096 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2097 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2098 left_x = s->x;
2099 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2100 ? last_x - 1
2101 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2102 top_y = s->y;
2103 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2104
2105 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2106 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2107 && (s->prev == NULL
2108 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2109 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2110 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2111 && (s->next == NULL
2112 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2113
2114 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2115
2116 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2117 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2118 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2119 else
2120 {
2121 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2122 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2123 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2124 }
2125 }
2126
2127
2128 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2129
2130 static void
2131 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2132 struct glyph_string *s;
2133 {
2134 int x;
2135 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2136
2137 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2138 right of that line. */
2139 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2140 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2141 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2142 else
2143 x = s->x;
2144
2145 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2146 by that margin. */
2147 x += s->img->hmargin;
2148 y += s->img->vmargin;
2149
2150 if (s->img->pixmap)
2151 {
2152 if (s->img->mask)
2153 {
2154 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2155 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2156 trust on the shape extension to be available
2157 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2158 manually. */
2159 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2160 | GCFunction);
2161 XGCValues xgcv;
2162 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2163
2164 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2165 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2166 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2167 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2168 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2169
2170 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2171 image_rect.x = x;
2172 image_rect.y = y;
2173 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2174 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2175 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2176 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2177 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2178 }
2179 else
2180 {
2181 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2182
2183 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2184 image_rect.x = x;
2185 image_rect.y = y;
2186 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2187 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2188 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2189 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2190 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2191
2192 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2193 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2194 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2195 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2196 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2197 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2198 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2199 {
2200 int r = s->img->relief;
2201 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2202 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2203 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2204 }
2205 }
2206 }
2207 else
2208 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2209 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2210 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2211 }
2212
2213
2214 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2215
2216 static void
2217 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2218 struct glyph_string *s;
2219 {
2220 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2221 XRectangle r;
2222 int x;
2223 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2224
2225 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2226 right of that line. */
2227 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2228 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2229 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2230 else
2231 x = s->x;
2232
2233 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2234 by that margin. */
2235 x += s->img->hmargin;
2236 y += s->img->vmargin;
2237
2238 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2239 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2240 {
2241 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2242 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2243 }
2244 else
2245 {
2246 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2247 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2248 }
2249
2250 x0 = x - thick;
2251 y0 = y - thick;
2252 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
2253 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
2254
2255 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2256 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2257 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
2258 }
2259
2260
2261 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2262
2263 static void
2264 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2265 struct glyph_string *s;
2266 Pixmap pixmap;
2267 {
2268 int x;
2269 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2270
2271 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2272 right of that line. */
2273 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2274 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2275 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2276 else
2277 x = 0;
2278
2279 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2280 by that margin. */
2281 x += s->img->hmargin;
2282 y += s->img->vmargin;
2283
2284 if (s->img->pixmap)
2285 {
2286 if (s->img->mask)
2287 {
2288 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2289 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2290 trust on the shape extension to be available
2291 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2292 manually. */
2293 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2294 | GCFunction);
2295 XGCValues xgcv;
2296
2297 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2298 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2299 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2300 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2301 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2302
2303 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2304 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2305 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2306 }
2307 else
2308 {
2309 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2310 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2311
2312 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2313 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2314 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2315 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2316 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2317 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2318 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2319 {
2320 int r = s->img->relief;
2321 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2322 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2323 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2324 }
2325 }
2326 }
2327 else
2328 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2329 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2330 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2331 }
2332
2333
2334 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2335 give the rectangle to draw. */
2336
2337 static void
2338 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2339 struct glyph_string *s;
2340 int x, y, w, h;
2341 {
2342 if (s->stippled_p)
2343 {
2344 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2345 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2346 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2347 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2348 }
2349 else
2350 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2351 }
2352
2353
2354 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2355
2356 s->y
2357 s->x +-------------------------
2358 | s->face->box
2359 |
2360 | +-------------------------
2361 | | s->img->margin
2362 | |
2363 | | +-------------------
2364 | | | the image
2365
2366 */
2367
2368 static void
2369 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2370 struct glyph_string *s;
2371 {
2372 int x, y;
2373 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2374 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2375 int height;
2376 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2377
2378 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
2379
2380
2381 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2382 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2383 flickering. */
2384 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2385 if (height > s->img->height
2386 || s->img->hmargin
2387 || s->img->vmargin
2388 || s->img->mask
2389 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2390 || s->width != s->background_width)
2391 {
2392 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2393 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
2394 else
2395 x = s->x;
2396
2397 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
2398
2399 if (s->img->mask)
2400 {
2401 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2402 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2403 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2404 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2405 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2406
2407 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2408 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2409 s->background_width,
2410 s->height, depth);
2411
2412 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2413 pixmap. */
2414 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2415
2416 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2417 if (s->stippled_p)
2418 {
2419 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2420 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2421 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2422 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2423 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2424 }
2425 else
2426 {
2427 XGCValues xgcv;
2428 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2429 &xgcv);
2430 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2431 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2432 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2433 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2434 }
2435 }
2436 else
2437 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2438
2439 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2440 }
2441
2442 /* Draw the foreground. */
2443 if (pixmap != None)
2444 {
2445 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2446 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2447 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2448 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2449 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2450 }
2451 else
2452 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2453
2454 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2455 if (s->img->relief
2456 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2457 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2458 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2459 }
2460
2461
2462 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2463
2464 static void
2465 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2466 struct glyph_string *s;
2467 {
2468 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2469 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2470
2471 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2472 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2473 {
2474 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2475 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2476 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2477
2478 /* Draw cursor. */
2479 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2480
2481 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2482 if (width < s->background_width)
2483 {
2484 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2485 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2486 XRectangle r;
2487 GC gc;
2488
2489 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2490 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2491 {
2492 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2493 gc = s->gc;
2494 }
2495 else
2496 gc = s->face->gc;
2497
2498 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2499 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2500
2501 if (s->face->stipple)
2502 {
2503 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2504 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2505 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2506 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2507 }
2508 else
2509 {
2510 XGCValues xgcv;
2511 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2512 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2513 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2514 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2515 }
2516 }
2517 }
2518 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2519 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2520 s->height);
2521
2522 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2523 }
2524
2525
2526 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2527
2528 static void
2529 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2530 struct glyph_string *s;
2531 {
2532 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2533
2534 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2535 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2536 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2537 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2538 {
2539 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2540 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2541 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2542 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2543 }
2544
2545 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2546 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2547
2548 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2549 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2550 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2551 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2552 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2553 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2554
2555 {
2556 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2557 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2558 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2559 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2560 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2561 }
2562 else
2563 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2564
2565 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2566 {
2567 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2568 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2569 break;
2570
2571 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2572 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2573 break;
2574
2575 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2576 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2577 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2578 else
2579 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2580 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2581 break;
2582
2583 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2584 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2585 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2586 else
2587 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2588 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2589 break;
2590
2591 default:
2592 abort ();
2593 }
2594
2595 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2596 {
2597 /* Draw underline. */
2598 if (s->face->underline_p)
2599 {
2600 unsigned long tem, h;
2601 int y;
2602
2603 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2604 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2605 h = 1;
2606
2607 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2608 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2609 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2610 specs, and its default is
2611
2612 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2613 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2614
2615 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2616 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2617 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2618 else if (s->face->font)
2619 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2620 else
2621 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2622
2623 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2624 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2625 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2626 else
2627 {
2628 XGCValues xgcv;
2629 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2630 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2631 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2632 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2633 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2634 }
2635 }
2636
2637 /* Draw overline. */
2638 if (s->face->overline_p)
2639 {
2640 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2641
2642 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2643 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2644 s->width, h);
2645 else
2646 {
2647 XGCValues xgcv;
2648 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2649 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2650 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2651 s->width, h);
2652 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2653 }
2654 }
2655
2656 /* Draw strike-through. */
2657 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2658 {
2659 unsigned long h = 1;
2660 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2661
2662 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2663 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2664 s->width, h);
2665 else
2666 {
2667 XGCValues xgcv;
2668 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2669 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2670 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2671 s->width, h);
2672 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2673 }
2674 }
2675
2676 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2677 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2678 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2679 }
2680
2681 /* Reset clipping. */
2682 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2683 }
2684
2685 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2686
2687 void
2688 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2689 struct frame *f;
2690 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2691 {
2692 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2693 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2694 x, y, width, height,
2695 x + shift_by, y);
2696 }
2697
2698 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2699 for X frames. */
2700
2701 static void
2702 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2703 register int n;
2704 {
2705 abort ();
2706 }
2707
2708
2709 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2710 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2711
2712 void
2713 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2714 Display *dpy;
2715 Window window;
2716 int x, y;
2717 int width, height;
2718 int exposures;
2719 {
2720 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2721 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2722 }
2723
2724
2725 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2726 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2727
2728 static void
2729 x_clear_frame ()
2730 {
2731 struct frame *f;
2732
2733 if (updating_frame)
2734 f = updating_frame;
2735 else
2736 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2737
2738 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2739 longer visible. */
2740 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2741 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2742 output_cursor.x = -1;
2743
2744 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2745 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2746 BLOCK_INPUT;
2747 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2748
2749 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2750 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2751 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2752
2753 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2754
2755 #ifdef USE_GTK
2756 xg_frame_cleared (f);
2757 #endif
2758
2759 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2760 }
2761
2762
2763 \f
2764 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2765
2766 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2767 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2768
2769 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2770
2771
2772 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2773 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2774
2775 static int
2776 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2777 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2778 {
2779 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2780 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2781 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2782 {
2783 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2784 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2785 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2786 }
2787
2788 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2789 {
2790 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2791 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2792 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2793 }
2794
2795 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2796 positive. */
2797 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2798 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2799
2800 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2801 negative. */
2802 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2803 }
2804
2805 void
2806 XTflash (f)
2807 struct frame *f;
2808 {
2809 BLOCK_INPUT;
2810
2811 {
2812 GC gc;
2813
2814 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2815 pixels into background pixels. */
2816 {
2817 XGCValues values;
2818
2819 values.function = GXxor;
2820 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2821 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2822
2823 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2824 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2825 }
2826
2827 {
2828 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2829 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2830 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2831 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2832 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2833 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2834 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2835
2836 int width;
2837
2838 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2839 edge it is next to. */
2840 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2841 {
2842 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2843 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2844 break;
2845
2846 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2847 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2848 break;
2849
2850 default:
2851 break;
2852 }
2853
2854 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2855
2856 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2857 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2858 {
2859 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2860 flash_left,
2861 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2862 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2863 width, flash_height);
2864 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2865 flash_left,
2866 (height - flash_height
2867 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2868 width, flash_height);
2869 }
2870 else
2871 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2872 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2873 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2874 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2875
2876 x_flush (f);
2877
2878 {
2879 struct timeval wakeup;
2880
2881 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2882
2883 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2884 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2885 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2886 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2887
2888 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2889 available. */
2890 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2891 {
2892 struct timeval current;
2893 struct timeval timeout;
2894
2895 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2896
2897 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2898 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2899 break;
2900
2901 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2902 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2903 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2904
2905 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2906 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2907 }
2908 }
2909
2910 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2911 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2912 {
2913 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2914 flash_left,
2915 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2916 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2917 width, flash_height);
2918 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2919 flash_left,
2920 (height - flash_height
2921 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2922 width, flash_height);
2923 }
2924 else
2925 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2928 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2929
2930 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2931 x_flush (f);
2932 }
2933 }
2934
2935 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2936 }
2937
2938 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
2939
2940
2941 /* Make audible bell. */
2942
2943 void
2944 XTring_bell ()
2945 {
2946 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2947
2948 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
2949 {
2950 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2951 if (visible_bell)
2952 XTflash (f);
2953 else
2954 #endif
2955 {
2956 BLOCK_INPUT;
2957 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
2958 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2959 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2960 }
2961 }
2962 }
2963
2964 \f
2965 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
2966 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
2967 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
2968 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
2969
2970 static void
2971 XTset_terminal_window (n)
2972 register int n;
2973 {
2974 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
2975 }
2976
2977
2978 \f
2979 /***********************************************************************
2980 Line Dance
2981 ***********************************************************************/
2982
2983 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
2984 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
2985
2986 static void
2987 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
2988 int vpos, n;
2989 {
2990 abort ();
2991 }
2992
2993
2994 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
2995
2996 static void
2997 x_scroll_run (w, run)
2998 struct window *w;
2999 struct run *run;
3000 {
3001 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3002 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3003
3004 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3005 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3006 fringe of W. */
3007 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3008
3009 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3010 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3011 bottom_y = y + height;
3012
3013 if (to_y < from_y)
3014 {
3015 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3016 line at the bottom. */
3017 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3018 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3019 else
3020 height = run->height;
3021 }
3022 else
3023 {
3024 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3025 at the bottom. */
3026 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3027 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3028 else
3029 height = run->height;
3030 }
3031
3032 BLOCK_INPUT;
3033
3034 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3035 updated_window = w;
3036 x_clear_cursor (w);
3037
3038 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3039 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3040 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3041 x, from_y,
3042 width, height,
3043 x, to_y);
3044
3045 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3046 }
3047
3048
3049 \f
3050 /***********************************************************************
3051 Exposure Events
3052 ***********************************************************************/
3053
3054 \f
3055 static void
3056 frame_highlight (f)
3057 struct frame *f;
3058 {
3059 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3060 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3061 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3062 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3063 BLOCK_INPUT;
3064 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3065 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3066 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3067 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3068 }
3069
3070 static void
3071 frame_unhighlight (f)
3072 struct frame *f;
3073 {
3074 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3075 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3076 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3077 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3078 BLOCK_INPUT;
3079 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3080 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3081 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3082 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3083 }
3084
3085 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3086 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3087 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3088 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3089 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3090
3091 static void
3092 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3093 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3094 struct frame *frame;
3095 {
3096 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3097
3098 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3099 {
3100 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3101 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3102 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3103
3104 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3105 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3106
3107 #if 0
3108 selected_frame = frame;
3109 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3110 selected_frame);
3111 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3112 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3113 #endif /* ! 0 */
3114
3115 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3116 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3117 else
3118 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3119 }
3120
3121 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3122 }
3123
3124 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3125 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3126 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into BUFP.
3127 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
3128
3129 static int
3130 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp, numchars)
3131 int type;
3132 int state;
3133 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3134 struct frame *frame;
3135 struct input_event *bufp;
3136 int numchars;
3137 {
3138 int nr_events = 0;
3139
3140 if (type == FocusIn)
3141 {
3142 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3143 {
3144 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3145 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3146
3147 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3148 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3149 if (numchars > 0
3150 && GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3151 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3152 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3153 {
3154 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3155 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3156 bufp->arg = Qnil;
3157 ++bufp;
3158 numchars--;
3159 ++nr_events;
3160 }
3161 }
3162
3163 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3164
3165 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3166 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3167 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3168 #endif
3169 }
3170 else if (type == FocusOut)
3171 {
3172 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3173
3174 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3175 {
3176 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3177 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3178 }
3179
3180 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3181 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3182 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3183 #endif
3184 }
3185
3186 return nr_events;
3187 }
3188
3189 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3190 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3191
3192 Returns number of events inserted into BUFP. */
3193
3194 static int
3195 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp, numchars)
3196 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3197 XEvent *event;
3198 struct input_event *bufp;
3199 int numchars;
3200 {
3201 struct frame *frame;
3202 int nr_events = 0;
3203
3204 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3205 if (! frame) return nr_events;
3206
3207 switch (event->type)
3208 {
3209 case EnterNotify:
3210 case LeaveNotify:
3211 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3212 && event->xcrossing.focus
3213 && ! (frame->output_data.x->focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3214 nr_events = x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify
3215 ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3216 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3217 dpyinfo,
3218 frame,
3219 bufp,
3220 numchars);
3221 break;
3222
3223 case FocusIn:
3224 case FocusOut:
3225 nr_events = x_focus_changed (event->type,
3226 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer
3227 ? FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3228 dpyinfo,
3229 frame,
3230 bufp,
3231 numchars);
3232 break;
3233 }
3234
3235 return nr_events;
3236 }
3237
3238
3239 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3240
3241 void
3242 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3243 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3244 {
3245 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3246 }
3247
3248 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3249 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3250 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3251
3252 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3253 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3254 the appropriate X display info. */
3255
3256 static void
3257 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3258 struct frame *frame;
3259 {
3260 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3261 }
3262
3263 static void
3264 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3265 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3266 {
3267 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3268
3269 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3270 {
3271 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3272 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3273 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3274 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3275 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3276 {
3277 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3278 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3279 }
3280 }
3281 else
3282 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3283
3284 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3285 {
3286 if (old_highlight)
3287 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3288 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3289 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3290 }
3291 }
3292
3293
3294 \f
3295 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3296
3297 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3298 static void
3299 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3300 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3301 {
3302 int min_code, max_code;
3303 KeySym *syms;
3304 int syms_per_code;
3305 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3306
3307 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3308 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3309 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3310 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3311 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3312
3313 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3314 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3315 #else
3316 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3317 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3318 #endif
3319
3320 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3321 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3322 &syms_per_code);
3323 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3324
3325 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3326 Alt keysyms are on. */
3327 {
3328 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3329
3330 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3331 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3332 {
3333 KeyCode code
3334 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3335
3336 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3337 if (code == 0)
3338 continue;
3339
3340 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3341 {
3342 int code_col;
3343
3344 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3345 {
3346 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3347
3348 switch (sym)
3349 {
3350 case XK_Meta_L:
3351 case XK_Meta_R:
3352 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3353 break;
3354
3355 case XK_Alt_L:
3356 case XK_Alt_R:
3357 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3358 break;
3359
3360 case XK_Hyper_L:
3361 case XK_Hyper_R:
3362 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3363 break;
3364
3365 case XK_Super_L:
3366 case XK_Super_R:
3367 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3368 break;
3369
3370 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3371 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3372 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
3373 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3374 break;
3375 }
3376 }
3377 }
3378 }
3379 }
3380
3381 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3382 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3383 {
3384 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3385 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3386 }
3387
3388 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3389 make them just meta, not alt. */
3390 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3391 {
3392 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3393 }
3394
3395 XFree ((char *) syms);
3396 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3397 }
3398
3399 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3400 Emacs uses. */
3401
3402 static unsigned int
3403 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3404 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3405 unsigned int state;
3406 {
3407 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3408 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3409 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3410 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3411 Lisp_Object tem;
3412
3413 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3414 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3415 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3416 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3417 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3418 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3419 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3420 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3421
3422
3423 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3424 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3425 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3426 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3427 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3428 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3429 }
3430
3431 static unsigned int
3432 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3433 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3434 unsigned int state;
3435 {
3436 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3437 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3438 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3439 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3440
3441 Lisp_Object tem;
3442
3443 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3444 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3445 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3446 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3447 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3448 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3449 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3450 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3451
3452
3453 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3454 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3455 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3456 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3457 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3458 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3459 }
3460
3461 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3462
3463 char *
3464 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3465 KeySym keysym;
3466 {
3467 char *value;
3468
3469 BLOCK_INPUT;
3470 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3471 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3472
3473 return value;
3474 }
3475
3476
3477 \f
3478 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3479
3480 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3481
3482 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3483 the mouse. */
3484
3485 static Lisp_Object
3486 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3487 struct input_event *result;
3488 XButtonEvent *event;
3489 struct frame *f;
3490 {
3491 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3492 otherwise. */
3493 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3494 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3495 result->timestamp = event->time;
3496 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3497 event->state)
3498 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3499 ? up_modifier
3500 : down_modifier));
3501
3502 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3503 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3504 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3505 result->arg = Qnil;
3506 return Qnil;
3507 }
3508
3509 \f
3510 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3511 The input handler calls this.
3512
3513 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3514 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3515 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3516 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3517
3518 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3519 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3520
3521 static void
3522 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3523 FRAME_PTR frame;
3524 XMotionEvent *event;
3525 {
3526 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3527 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3528 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3529
3530 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3531 {
3532 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3533 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3534 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3535 }
3536
3537 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3538 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3539 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3540 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3541 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3542 {
3543 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3544 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3545 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3546 }
3547 }
3548
3549 \f
3550 /************************************************************************
3551 Mouse Face
3552 ************************************************************************/
3553
3554 static void
3555 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3556 {
3557 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3558 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3559 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3560 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3561 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3562 }
3563
3564
3565 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3566
3567
3568 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3569 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3570 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3571 values. */
3572
3573 static int
3574 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3575 struct frame *f;
3576 int x, y;
3577 XRectangle *rect;
3578 {
3579 Lisp_Object window;
3580 int found = 0;
3581
3582 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3583 if (!NILP (window))
3584 {
3585 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
3586 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3587 struct glyph_row *end = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3588
3589 for (; !found && r < end && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3590 if (r->y >= y)
3591 {
3592 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3593 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3594 int gx;
3595
3596 for (gx = r->x; !found && g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
3597 if (gx >= x)
3598 {
3599 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3600 rect->height = r->height;
3601 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3602 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3603 found = 1;
3604 }
3605 }
3606 }
3607
3608 return found;
3609 }
3610
3611
3612 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3613 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3614
3615 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3616 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3617 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3618 position on the scroll bar.
3619
3620 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3621 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3622 the mouse is over.
3623
3624 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3625 was at this position.
3626
3627 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3628
3629 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3630 movement. */
3631
3632 static void
3633 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3634 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3635 int insist;
3636 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3637 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3638 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3639 unsigned long *time;
3640 {
3641 FRAME_PTR f1;
3642
3643 BLOCK_INPUT;
3644
3645 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3646 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3647 else
3648 {
3649 Window root;
3650 int root_x, root_y;
3651
3652 Window dummy_window;
3653 int dummy;
3654
3655 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3656
3657 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3658 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3659 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3660 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3661
3662 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3663
3664 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3665 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3666 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3667
3668 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3669 &root,
3670
3671 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3672 a different screen. */
3673 &dummy_window,
3674
3675 /* The position on that root window. */
3676 &root_x, &root_y,
3677
3678 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3679 &dummy, &dummy,
3680
3681 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3682 we don't care. */
3683 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3684
3685 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3686 containing the pointer. */
3687 {
3688 Window win, child;
3689 int win_x, win_y;
3690 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3691 int count;
3692
3693 win = root;
3694
3695 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3696 structure is changing at the same time this function
3697 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3698
3699 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3700
3701 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3702 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3703 {
3704 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3705 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3706 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3707
3708 /* From-window, to-window. */
3709 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3710
3711 /* From-position, to-position. */
3712 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3713
3714 /* Child of win. */
3715 &child);
3716 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3717 }
3718 else
3719 {
3720 while (1)
3721 {
3722 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3723
3724 /* From-window, to-window. */
3725 root, win,
3726
3727 /* From-position, to-position. */
3728 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3729
3730 /* Child of win. */
3731 &child);
3732
3733 if (child == None || child == win)
3734 break;
3735
3736 win = child;
3737 parent_x = win_x;
3738 parent_y = win_y;
3739 }
3740
3741 /* Now we know that:
3742 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3743 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3744 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3745 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3746 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3747 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3748 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3749 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3750 never use them in that case.) */
3751
3752 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3753 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3754
3755 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3756 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3757 on the frame. */
3758 if (f1 != NULL
3759 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3760 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3761 f1 = NULL;
3762 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3763 }
3764
3765 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3766 f1 = 0;
3767
3768 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3769
3770 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3771 if (! f1)
3772 {
3773 struct scroll_bar *bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (win);
3774
3775 if (bar)
3776 {
3777 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3778 win_x = parent_x;
3779 win_y = parent_y;
3780 }
3781 }
3782
3783 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3784 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3785
3786 if (f1)
3787 {
3788 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3789 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3790 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3791 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3792 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3793 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3794 the frame are divided into. */
3795
3796 int width, height, gx, gy;
3797 XRectangle rect;
3798
3799 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3800 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3801 else
3802 {
3803 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3804 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3805 gx = win_x;
3806 gy = win_y;
3807
3808 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3809 round down even for negative values. */
3810 if (gx < 0)
3811 gx -= width - 1;
3812 if (gy < 0)
3813 gy -= height - 1;
3814 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3815 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3816
3817 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3818 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3819 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3820 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3821 }
3822
3823 *bar_window = Qnil;
3824 *part = 0;
3825 *fp = f1;
3826 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3827 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3828 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3829 }
3830 }
3831 }
3832
3833 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3834 }
3835
3836
3837 \f
3838 /***********************************************************************
3839 Scroll bars
3840 ***********************************************************************/
3841
3842 /* Scroll bar support. */
3843
3844 /* Given an X window ID, find the struct scroll_bar which manages it.
3845 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3846 bits. */
3847
3848 static struct scroll_bar *
3849 x_window_to_scroll_bar (window_id)
3850 Window window_id;
3851 {
3852 Lisp_Object tail;
3853
3854 #ifdef USE_GTK
3855 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (window_id);
3856 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3857
3858 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3859 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3860 tail = XCDR (tail))
3861 {
3862 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3863
3864 frame = XCAR (tail);
3865 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3866 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3867 abort ();
3868
3869 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3870 right window ID. */
3871 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3872 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3873 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3874 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3875 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3876 condemned = Qnil,
3877 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3878 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3879 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id)
3880 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3881 }
3882
3883 return 0;
3884 }
3885
3886
3887 #if defined USE_LUCID
3888
3889 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3890 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3891
3892 static Widget
3893 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3894 Window window;
3895 {
3896 Lisp_Object tail;
3897
3898 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3899 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3900 tail = XCDR (tail))
3901 {
3902 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3903 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3904
3905 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3906 return menu_bar;
3907 }
3908
3909 return NULL;
3910 }
3911
3912 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3913
3914 \f
3915 /************************************************************************
3916 Toolkit scroll bars
3917 ************************************************************************/
3918
3919 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3920
3921 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3922 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3923 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3924 struct scroll_bar *));
3925 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3926 int, int, int));
3927
3928
3929 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3930 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3931
3932 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3933
3934 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3935
3936 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3937
3938 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3939 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3940
3941 #ifndef USE_GTK
3942 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3943
3944 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3945
3946 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3947
3948 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3949 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3950 to avoid jerkyness. */
3951
3952 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3953
3954 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
3955
3956 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3957 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3958 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3959 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3960
3961 static void
3962 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3963 num_params)
3964 Widget widget;
3965 XtPointer client_data;
3966 String action_name;
3967 XEvent *event;
3968 String *params;
3969 Cardinal *num_params;
3970 {
3971 int scroll_bar_p;
3972 char *end_action;
3973
3974 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
3975 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
3976 end_action = "Release";
3977 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
3978 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
3979 end_action = "EndScroll";
3980 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
3981
3982 if (scroll_bar_p
3983 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
3984 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
3985 {
3986 struct window *w;
3987
3988 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
3989 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
3990 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
3991
3992 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
3993 {
3994 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
3995 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
3996 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
3997 }
3998 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
3999 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4000
4001 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4002 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4003 }
4004 }
4005 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4006
4007 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4008 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4009
4010 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4011 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4012
4013
4014 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4015 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4016 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4017 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4018
4019 static void
4020 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4021 Lisp_Object window;
4022 int part, portion, whole;
4023 {
4024 XEvent event;
4025 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4026 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4027 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4028 int i;
4029
4030 BLOCK_INPUT;
4031
4032 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4033 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4034 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4035 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4036 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4037 ev->format = 32;
4038
4039 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4040 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4041 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4042 into that array in the event. */
4043 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4044 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4045 break;
4046
4047 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4048 {
4049 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4050 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4051 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4052
4053 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4054 nbytes);
4055 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4056 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4057 }
4058
4059 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4060 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4061 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4062 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4063 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4064 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4065
4066 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4067 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4068
4069 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4070 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4071 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4072 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4073 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4074 }
4075
4076
4077 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4078 in *IEVENT. */
4079
4080 static void
4081 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4082 XEvent *event;
4083 struct input_event *ievent;
4084 {
4085 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4086 Lisp_Object window;
4087 struct frame *f;
4088 struct window *w;
4089
4090 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4091 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4092
4093 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4094 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4095
4096 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4097 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4098 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4099 #ifdef USE_GTK
4100 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4101 #else
4102 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4103 #endif
4104 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4105 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4106 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4107 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4108 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4109 }
4110
4111
4112 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4113
4114 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4115
4116 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4117
4118
4119 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4120 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4121 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4122
4123 static void
4124 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4125 Widget widget;
4126 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4127 {
4128 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4129 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4130 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4131
4132 switch (cs->reason)
4133 {
4134 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4135 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4136 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4137 break;
4138
4139 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4140 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4141 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4142 break;
4143
4144 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4145 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4146 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4147 break;
4148
4149 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4150 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4151 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4152 break;
4153
4154 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4155 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4156 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4157 break;
4158
4159 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4160 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4161 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4162 break;
4163
4164 case XmCR_DRAG:
4165 {
4166 int slider_size;
4167
4168 /* Get the slider size. */
4169 BLOCK_INPUT;
4170 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4171 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4172
4173 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4174 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4175 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4176 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4177 }
4178 break;
4179
4180 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4181 break;
4182 };
4183
4184 if (part >= 0)
4185 {
4186 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4187 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4188 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4189 }
4190 }
4191
4192
4193 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4194 #ifdef USE_GTK
4195 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4196 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4197
4198 static void
4199 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4200 GtkRange *widget;
4201 gpointer data;
4202 {
4203 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4204 gdouble previous;
4205 gdouble position;
4206 gdouble *p;
4207 int diff;
4208
4209 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4210 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4211
4212 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4213
4214 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4215
4216 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4217 if (! p)
4218 {
4219 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4220 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4221 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4222 }
4223
4224 previous = *p;
4225 *p = position;
4226
4227 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4228
4229 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4230 {
4231 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4232 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4233 }
4234 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4235 {
4236 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4237 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4238 }
4239 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4240 {
4241 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4242 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4243 }
4244 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4245 {
4246 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4247 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4248 }
4249 else
4250 {
4251 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4252 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4253 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4254 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4255 }
4256
4257 if (part >= 0)
4258 {
4259 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4260 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4261 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4262 }
4263 }
4264
4265 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4266
4267 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4268 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4269 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4270 the thumb is. */
4271
4272 static void
4273 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4274 Widget widget;
4275 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4276 {
4277 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4278 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4279 float shown;
4280 int whole, portion, height;
4281 int part;
4282
4283 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4284 BLOCK_INPUT;
4285 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4286 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4287
4288 whole = 10000000;
4289 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4290
4291 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4292 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4293 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4294 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4295 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4296 bottom). */
4297 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4298 else
4299 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4300
4301 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4302 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4303 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4304 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4305 }
4306
4307
4308 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4309 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4310 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4311 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4312 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4313 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4314 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4315
4316 static void
4317 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4318 Widget widget;
4319 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4320 {
4321 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4322 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4323 int position = (long) call_data;
4324 Dimension height;
4325 int part;
4326
4327 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4328 BLOCK_INPUT;
4329 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4331
4332 if (abs (position) >= height)
4333 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4334
4335 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4336 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4337 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4338 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4339 else
4340 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4341
4342 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4343 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4344 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4345 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4346 }
4347
4348 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4349 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4350
4351 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4352
4353 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4354 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4355
4356 #ifdef USE_GTK
4357 static void
4358 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4359 struct frame *f;
4360 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4361 {
4362 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4363
4364 BLOCK_INPUT;
4365 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4366 scroll_bar_name);
4367 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4368 }
4369
4370 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4371
4372 static void
4373 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4374 struct frame *f;
4375 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4376 {
4377 Window xwindow;
4378 Widget widget;
4379 Arg av[20];
4380 int ac = 0;
4381 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4382 unsigned long pixel;
4383
4384 BLOCK_INPUT;
4385
4386 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4387 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4388 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4389 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4390 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4391 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4392 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4393 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4394 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4395
4396 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4397 if (pixel != -1)
4398 {
4399 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4400 ++ac;
4401 }
4402
4403 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4404 if (pixel != -1)
4405 {
4406 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4407 ++ac;
4408 }
4409
4410 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4411 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4412
4413 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4414 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4415 (XtPointer) bar);
4416 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4417 (XtPointer) bar);
4418 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4419 (XtPointer) bar);
4420 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4421 (XtPointer) bar);
4422 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4423 (XtPointer) bar);
4424 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4425 (XtPointer) bar);
4426 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4427 (XtPointer) bar);
4428
4429 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4430 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4431
4432 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4433 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4434 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4435 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4436
4437 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4438
4439 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4440 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4441 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4442 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4443 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4444 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4445 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4446 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4447
4448 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4449 if (pixel != -1)
4450 {
4451 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4452 ++ac;
4453 }
4454
4455 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4456 if (pixel != -1)
4457 {
4458 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4459 ++ac;
4460 }
4461
4462 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4463
4464 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4465 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4466 {
4467 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4468 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4469 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4470 pixel = -1;
4471 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4472 }
4473 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4474 {
4475 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4476 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4477 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4478 pixel = -1;
4479 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4480 }
4481
4482 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4483 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4484 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4485 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4486 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4487 {
4488 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4489 ++ac;
4490 }
4491 else
4492 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4493 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4494 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4495 {
4496 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4497 the shadows. */
4498 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4499 ++ac;
4500
4501 /* Specify the colors. */
4502 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4503 if (pixel != -1)
4504 {
4505 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4506 ++ac;
4507 }
4508 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4509 if (pixel != -1)
4510 {
4511 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4512 ++ac;
4513 }
4514 }
4515
4516 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4517 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4518
4519 {
4520 char *initial = "";
4521 char *val = initial;
4522 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4523 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4524 if (val == initial)
4525 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4526 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4527 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4528 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4529 }
4530 }
4531
4532 /* Define callbacks. */
4533 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4534 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4535 (XtPointer) bar);
4536
4537 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4538 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4539
4540 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4541
4542 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4543 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4544 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4545 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4546
4547 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4548 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4549 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4550 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4551
4552 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4553 }
4554 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4555
4556
4557 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4558 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4559
4560 #ifdef USE_GTK
4561 static void
4562 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4563 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4564 int portion, position, whole;
4565 {
4566 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4567 }
4568
4569 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4570 static void
4571 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4572 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4573 int portion, position, whole;
4574 {
4575 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4576 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4577 float top, shown;
4578
4579 BLOCK_INPUT;
4580
4581 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4582
4583 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4584 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4585 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4586 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4587 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4588 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4589 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4590 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4591 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4592 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4593 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4594 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4595 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4596 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4597 whole += portion;
4598
4599 if (whole <= 0)
4600 top = 0, shown = 1;
4601 else
4602 {
4603 top = (float) position / whole;
4604 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4605 }
4606
4607 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4608 {
4609 int size, value;
4610
4611 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4612 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4613 value. */
4614 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4615 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4616 size = max (size, 1);
4617
4618 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4619 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4620 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4621
4622 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4623 }
4624 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4625
4626 if (whole == 0)
4627 top = 0, shown = 1;
4628 else
4629 {
4630 top = (float) position / whole;
4631 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4632 }
4633
4634 {
4635 float old_top, old_shown;
4636 Dimension height;
4637 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4638 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4639 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4640 XtNheight, &height,
4641 NULL);
4642
4643 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4644 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4645 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4646 else
4647 top = old_top;
4648 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4649 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4650
4651 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4652 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4653 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4654 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4655 {
4656 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4657 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4658 else
4659 {
4660 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4661 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4662 int scroll_mode = 0;
4663
4664 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4665 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4666 {
4667 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4668 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4669 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4670 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4671 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4672 }
4673 #endif
4674 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4675 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4676 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4677
4678 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4679
4680 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4681 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4682 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4683 #endif
4684 }
4685 }
4686 }
4687 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4688
4689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4690 }
4691 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4692
4693 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4694
4695
4696 \f
4697 /************************************************************************
4698 Scroll bars, general
4699 ************************************************************************/
4700
4701 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4702 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4703 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4704 scroll bar. */
4705
4706 static struct scroll_bar *
4707 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4708 struct window *w;
4709 int top, left, width, height;
4710 {
4711 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4712 struct scroll_bar *bar
4713 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4714
4715 BLOCK_INPUT;
4716
4717 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4718 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4719 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4720 {
4721 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4722 unsigned long mask;
4723 Window window;
4724
4725 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4726 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4727 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4728
4729 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4730 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4731 | ExposureMask);
4732 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4733
4734 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4735
4736 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4737 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4738 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4739 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4740 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4741 left, top, width,
4742 window_box_height (w), False);
4743
4744 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4745 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4746 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4747 top,
4748 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4749 height,
4750 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4751 0,
4752 CopyFromParent,
4753 CopyFromParent,
4754 CopyFromParent,
4755 /* Attributes. */
4756 mask, &a);
4757 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4758 }
4759 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4760
4761 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4762 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4763 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4764 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4765 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4766 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4767 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4768 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4769
4770 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4771 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4772 bar->prev = Qnil;
4773 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4774 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4775 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4776
4777 /* Map the window/widget. */
4778 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4779 {
4780 #ifdef USE_GTK
4781 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4782 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4783 top,
4784 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4785 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4786 max (height, 1),
4787 left,
4788 width);
4789 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4790 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4791 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4792 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4793 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4794 top,
4795 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4796 max (height, 1), 0);
4797 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4798 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4799 }
4800 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4801 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4802 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4803
4804 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4805 return bar;
4806 }
4807
4808
4809 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4810
4811 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4812 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4813 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4814 events.)
4815
4816 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4817 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4818 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4819 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4820 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4821
4822 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4823
4824 static void
4825 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4826 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4827 int start, end;
4828 int rebuild;
4829 {
4830 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4831 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4832 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4833 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4834
4835 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4836 if (! rebuild
4837 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4838 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4839 return;
4840
4841 BLOCK_INPUT;
4842
4843 {
4844 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4845 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4846 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4847
4848 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4849 the distance between start and end. */
4850 {
4851 int length = end - start;
4852
4853 if (start < 0)
4854 start = 0;
4855 else if (start > top_range)
4856 start = top_range;
4857 end = start + length;
4858
4859 if (end < start)
4860 end = start;
4861 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4862 end = top_range;
4863 }
4864
4865 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4866 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4867 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4868
4869 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4870 if (end > top_range)
4871 end = top_range;
4872
4873 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4874 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4875 that many pixels tall. */
4876 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4877
4878 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4879 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4880 if (0 < start)
4881 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4882 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4883 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4884 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4885 inside_width, start,
4886 False);
4887
4888 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4889 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4890 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4891 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4892
4893 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4894 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4895 /* x, y, width, height */
4896 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4897 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4898 inside_width, end - start);
4899
4900 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4901 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4902 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4903 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4904
4905 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4906 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4907 if (end < inside_height)
4908 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4909 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4910 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4911 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4912 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4913 False);
4914
4915 }
4916
4917 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4918 }
4919
4920 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4921
4922 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4923 nil. */
4924
4925 static void
4926 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4927 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4928 {
4929 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4930 BLOCK_INPUT;
4931
4932 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4933 #ifdef USE_GTK
4934 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4935 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4936 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4937 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4938 #else
4939 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4940 #endif
4941
4942 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4943 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4944
4945 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4946 }
4947
4948
4949 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4950 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4951 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4952 create one. */
4953
4954 static void
4955 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4956 struct window *w;
4957 int portion, whole, position;
4958 {
4959 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4960 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4961 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4962 int window_y, window_height;
4963
4964 /* Get window dimensions. */
4965 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4966 top = window_y;
4967 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4968 height = window_height;
4969
4970 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4971 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4972
4973 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4974 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4975 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4976 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4977 else
4978 sb_width = width;
4979
4980 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4981 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4982 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4983 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
4984 else
4985 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
4986 #else
4987 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4988 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
4989 else
4990 sb_left = left;
4991 #endif
4992
4993 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
4994 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
4995 {
4996 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4997 {
4998 BLOCK_INPUT;
4999 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5000 left, top, width, height, False);
5001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5002 }
5003
5004 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5005 }
5006 else
5007 {
5008 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5009 unsigned int mask = 0;
5010
5011 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5012
5013 BLOCK_INPUT;
5014
5015 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5016 mask |= CWX;
5017 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5018 mask |= CWY;
5019 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5020 mask |= CWWidth;
5021 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5022 mask |= CWHeight;
5023
5024 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5025
5026 #ifdef USE_GTK
5027 if (mask)
5028 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5029 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5030 top,
5031 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5032 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5033 max (height, 1),
5034 left,
5035 width);
5036 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5037
5038 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5039 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5040 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5041 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5042 left, top, width, height, False);
5043 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5044 if (mask)
5045 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5046 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5047 top,
5048 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5049 max (height, 1), 0);
5050
5051 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5052 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5053
5054 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5055 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5056 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5057 {
5058 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5059 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5060 height, False);
5061 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5062 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5063 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5064 height, False);
5065 }
5066
5067 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5068 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5069 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5070 example. */
5071 {
5072 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5073 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5074 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5075 {
5076 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left + area_width - rest, top,
5079 rest, height, False);
5080 else
5081 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5082 left, top, rest, height, False);
5083 }
5084 }
5085
5086 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5087 if (mask)
5088 {
5089 XWindowChanges wc;
5090
5091 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5092 wc.y = top;
5093 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5094 wc.height = height;
5095 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5096 mask, &wc);
5097 }
5098
5099 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5100
5101 /* Remember new settings. */
5102 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5103 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5104 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5105 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5106
5107 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5108 }
5109
5110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5111 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5112 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5113 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5114 dragged. */
5115 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5116 {
5117 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5118
5119 if (whole == 0)
5120 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5121 else
5122 {
5123 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5124 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5125 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5126 }
5127 }
5128 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5129
5130 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5131 }
5132
5133
5134 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5135 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5136 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5137 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5138 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5139 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5140 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5141
5142 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5143 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5144 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5145
5146 static void
5147 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5148 FRAME_PTR frame;
5149 {
5150 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5151 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5152 {
5153 Lisp_Object bar;
5154 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5155 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5156 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5157 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5158 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5159 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5160 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5161 }
5162 }
5163
5164
5165 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5166 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5167
5168 static void
5169 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5170 struct window *window;
5171 {
5172 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5173 struct frame *f;
5174
5175 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5176 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5177 abort ();
5178
5179 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5180
5181 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5182 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5183 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5184 {
5185 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5186 the lists. */
5187 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5188 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5189 return;
5190 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5191 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5192 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5193 else
5194 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5195 one or the other! */
5196 abort ();
5197 }
5198 else
5199 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5200
5201 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5202 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5203
5204 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5205 bar->prev = Qnil;
5206 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5207 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5208 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5209 }
5210
5211 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5212 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5213
5214 static void
5215 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5216 FRAME_PTR f;
5217 {
5218 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5219
5220 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5221
5222 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5223 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5224 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5225
5226 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5227 {
5228 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5229
5230 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5231
5232 next = b->next;
5233 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5234 }
5235
5236 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5237 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5238 }
5239
5240
5241 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5242 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5243 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5244
5245 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5246 mark bits. */
5247
5248 static void
5249 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5250 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5251 XEvent *event;
5252 {
5253 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5254 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5255 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5256 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5257
5258 BLOCK_INPUT;
5259
5260 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5261
5262 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5263 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5264
5265 /* x, y, width, height */
5266 0, 0,
5267 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5268 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5269
5270 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5271
5272 }
5273 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5274
5275 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5276 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5277
5278 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5279 mark bits. */
5280
5281
5282 static void
5283 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5284 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5285 XEvent *event;
5286 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5287 {
5288 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5289 abort ();
5290
5291 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5292 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5293 emacs_event->modifiers
5294 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5295 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5296 event->xbutton.state)
5297 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5298 ? up_modifier
5299 : down_modifier));
5300 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5301 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5302 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5303 {
5304 #if 0
5305 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5306 int internal_height
5307 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5308 #endif
5309 int top_range
5310 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5311 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5312
5313 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5314 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5315
5316 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5317 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5318 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5319 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5320 else
5321 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5322
5323 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5324 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5325 whether or not we're dragging. */
5326 #if 0
5327 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5328 holding it. */
5329 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5330 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5331 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5332 #endif
5333
5334 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5335 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5336 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5337 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5338 {
5339 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5340 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5341
5342 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5343 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5344 }
5345 #endif
5346
5347 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5348 #if 0
5349 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5350 the handle. */
5351 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5352 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5353 else
5354 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5355 #else
5356 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5357 #endif
5358
5359 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5360 }
5361 }
5362
5363 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5364
5365 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5366
5367 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5368 mark bits. */
5369
5370 static void
5371 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5372 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5373 XEvent *event;
5374 {
5375 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5376
5377 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5378
5379 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5380 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5381
5382 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5383 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5384 {
5385 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5386 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5387
5388 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5389 {
5390 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5391
5392 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5393 }
5394 }
5395 }
5396
5397 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5398
5399 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5400 on the scroll bar. */
5401
5402 static void
5403 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5404 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5405 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5406 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5407 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5408 unsigned long *time;
5409 {
5410 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5411 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5412 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5413 int win_x, win_y;
5414 Window dummy_window;
5415 int dummy_coord;
5416 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5417
5418 BLOCK_INPUT;
5419
5420 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5421 report that. */
5422 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5423
5424 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5425 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5426 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5427
5428 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5429 &win_x, &win_y,
5430
5431 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5432 &dummy_mask))
5433 ;
5434 else
5435 {
5436 #if 0
5437 int inside_height
5438 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5439 #endif
5440 int top_range
5441 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5442
5443 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5444
5445 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5446 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5447
5448 if (win_y < 0)
5449 win_y = 0;
5450 if (win_y > top_range)
5451 win_y = top_range;
5452
5453 *fp = f;
5454 *bar_window = bar->window;
5455
5456 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5457 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5458 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5459 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5460 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5461 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5462 else
5463 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5464
5465 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5466 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5467
5468 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5469 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5470 }
5471
5472 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5473
5474 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5475 }
5476
5477
5478 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5479 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5480 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5481 redraw them. */
5482
5483 void
5484 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5485 FRAME_PTR f;
5486 {
5487 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5488 Lisp_Object bar;
5489
5490 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5491 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5492 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5493 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5494 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5495 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5496 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5497 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5498 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5499 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5500 }
5501
5502 \f
5503 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
5504
5505 struct selection_event_queue
5506 {
5507 XEvent event;
5508 struct selection_event_queue *next;
5509 };
5510
5511 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
5512
5513 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
5514
5515 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
5516
5517 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
5518
5519 static void
5520 x_queue_event (f, event)
5521 FRAME_PTR f;
5522 XEvent *event;
5523 {
5524 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
5525 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
5526
5527 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
5528 {
5529 queue_tmp->event = *event;
5530 queue_tmp->next = queue;
5531 queue = queue_tmp;
5532 }
5533 }
5534
5535 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
5536 so that they get processed afresh. */
5537
5538 static void
5539 x_unqueue_events (display)
5540 Display *display;
5541 {
5542 while (queue != NULL)
5543 {
5544 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
5545 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
5546 queue = queue_tmp->next;
5547 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
5548 }
5549 }
5550
5551 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5552
5553 void
5554 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5555 Display *display;
5556 {
5557 x_queue_selection_requests++;
5558 }
5559
5560 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5561
5562 void
5563 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5564 Display *display;
5565 {
5566 x_queue_selection_requests--;
5567 x_unqueue_events (display);
5568 }
5569 \f
5570 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5571
5572 #if 0
5573 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5574 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5575 sometimes don't work. */
5576
5577 static Time enter_timestamp;
5578 #endif
5579
5580 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5581 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5582 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5583 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5584
5585 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5586 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5587
5588 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5589
5590 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5591 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5592
5593 static int temp_index;
5594 static short temp_buffer[100];
5595
5596 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5597 on a particular display. */
5598
5599 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5600
5601 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5602 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5603 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5604 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5605
5606 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5607
5608 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5609 do \
5610 { \
5611 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5612 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5613 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5614 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5615 if (numchars >= 1) \
5616 { \
5617 bufp->kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5618 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f); \
5619 bufp->arg = Qnil; \
5620 bufp++; \
5621 count++; \
5622 numchars--; \
5623 } \
5624 } \
5625 while (0)
5626
5627 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5628 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5629
5630
5631 enum
5632 {
5633 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5634 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5635 X_EVENT_DROP
5636 };
5637
5638 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5639 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5640 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5641
5642 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5643 this event further.
5644 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5645
5646 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5647 static int
5648 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5649 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5650 XEvent *event;
5651 {
5652 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5653 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5654 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5655 was created. */
5656
5657 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5658 event->xclient.window);
5659
5660 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5661 }
5662 #endif
5663
5664 #ifdef USE_GTK
5665 static struct x_display_info *current_dpyinfo;
5666 static struct input_event **current_bufp;
5667 static int *current_numcharsp;
5668 static int current_count;
5669 static int current_finish;
5670
5671 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5672 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5673 so we have a chanse to act on the event before GTK. */
5674 static GdkFilterReturn
5675 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5676 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5677 GdkEvent *ev;
5678 gpointer data;
5679 {
5680 XEvent *xev = (XEvent*)gxev;
5681
5682 if (current_numcharsp)
5683 {
5684 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5685 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5686 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5687 so we do it here. */
5688 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5689 if (x_filter_event (current_dpyinfo, xev))
5690 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5691 #endif
5692 current_count += handle_one_xevent (current_dpyinfo,
5693 xev,
5694 current_bufp,
5695 current_numcharsp,
5696 &current_finish);
5697 }
5698 else
5699 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, GDK_DISPLAY ());
5700
5701 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5702 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5703
5704 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5705 }
5706 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5707
5708
5709 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5710
5711 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5712 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5713 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5714
5715 Events representing keys are stored in buffer *BUFP_R,
5716 which can hold up to *NUMCHARSP characters.
5717 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5718
5719 static int
5720 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, bufp_r, numcharsp, finish)
5721 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5722 XEvent *eventp;
5723 /* register */ struct input_event **bufp_r;
5724 /* register */ int *numcharsp;
5725 int *finish;
5726 {
5727 int count = 0;
5728 int nbytes = 0;
5729 struct frame *f;
5730 struct coding_system coding;
5731 struct input_event *bufp = *bufp_r;
5732 int numchars = *numcharsp;
5733 XEvent event = *eventp;
5734
5735 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5736
5737 switch (event.type)
5738 {
5739 case ClientMessage:
5740 {
5741 if (event.xclient.message_type
5742 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5743 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5744 {
5745 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5746 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5747 {
5748 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5749 could be the shell widget window
5750 if the frame has no title bar. */
5751 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5752 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5753 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5754 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5755 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5756 #endif
5757 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5758 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5759 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5760 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5761 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5762 needed.
5763
5764 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5765 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5766 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5767 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5768 Emacs. */
5769
5770 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5771 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5772 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5773 if (f)
5774 {
5775 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5776 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5777 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5778 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5779 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5780 /* The ICCCM says this is
5781 the only valid choice. */
5782 RevertToParent,
5783 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5784 /* This is needed to detect the error
5785 if there is an error. */
5786 XSync (d, False);
5787 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5788 }
5789 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5790 #endif /* 0 */
5791 }
5792 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5793 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5794 {
5795 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5796 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5797 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5798 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5799 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5800 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5801 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5802 session manager and one for this. */
5803 if (numchars > 0
5804 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5805 && ! x_session_have_connection ()
5806 #endif
5807 )
5808 {
5809 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5810 event.xclient.window);
5811 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5812 for a single Emacs process. */
5813 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5814 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5815 event.xclient.window,
5816 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5817 else if (f)
5818 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5819 event.xclient.window,
5820 0, 0);
5821 }
5822 }
5823 else if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5824 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5825 {
5826 struct frame *f
5827 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5828 event.xclient.window);
5829
5830 if (f)
5831 {
5832 if (numchars == 0)
5833 abort ();
5834
5835 bufp->kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5836 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
5837 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5838 bufp++;
5839
5840 count += 1;
5841 numchars -= 1;
5842 }
5843 else
5844 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5845 }
5846 }
5847 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5848 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5849 {
5850 }
5851 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5852 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5853 {
5854 int new_x, new_y;
5855 struct frame *f
5856 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5857
5858 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5859 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5860
5861 if (f)
5862 {
5863 f->left_pos = new_x;
5864 f->top_pos = new_y;
5865 }
5866 }
5867 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5868 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5869 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5870 {
5871 struct frame *f
5872 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5873 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5874 &event, NULL);
5875 }
5876 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5877 else if ((event.xclient.message_type
5878 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5879 || (event.xclient.message_type
5880 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5881 {
5882 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5883 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5884 currently never do because we are interested in
5885 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5886 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5887 struct frame *f
5888 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5889 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5890 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5891 }
5892 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5893 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5894 we construct an input_event. */
5895 else if (event.xclient.message_type
5896 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5897 {
5898 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, bufp);
5899 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
5900 goto out;
5901 }
5902 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5903 else
5904 goto OTHER;
5905 }
5906 break;
5907
5908 case SelectionNotify:
5909 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5910 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5911 goto OTHER;
5912 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5913 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5914 break;
5915
5916 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5917 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5918 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5919 goto OTHER;
5920 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5921 {
5922 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5923
5924 if (numchars == 0)
5925 abort ();
5926
5927 bufp->kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5928 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
5929 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
5930 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
5931 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
5932 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5933 bufp++;
5934
5935 count += 1;
5936 numchars -= 1;
5937 }
5938 break;
5939
5940 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5941 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5942 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5943 goto OTHER;
5944 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5945 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
5946 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
5947 &event);
5948 else
5949 {
5950 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5951 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5952
5953 if (numchars == 0)
5954 abort ();
5955
5956 bufp->kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5957 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (bufp) = eventp->display;
5958 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (bufp) = eventp->requestor;
5959 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (bufp) = eventp->selection;
5960 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (bufp) = eventp->target;
5961 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (bufp) = eventp->property;
5962 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (bufp) = eventp->time;
5963 bufp->frame_or_window = Qnil;
5964 bufp->arg = Qnil;
5965 bufp++;
5966
5967 count += 1;
5968 numchars -= 1;
5969 }
5970 break;
5971
5972 case PropertyNotify:
5973 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5974 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5975 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5976 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5977 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5978 goto OTHER;
5979 #endif
5980 #endif
5981 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5982 goto OTHER;
5983
5984 case ReparentNotify:
5985 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5986 if (f)
5987 {
5988 int x, y;
5989 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5990 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5991 f->left_pos = x;
5992 f->top_pos = y;
5993 }
5994 goto OTHER;
5995 break;
5996
5997 case Expose:
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5999 if (f)
6000 {
6001 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6002
6003 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6004 {
6005 f->async_visible = 1;
6006 f->async_iconified = 0;
6007 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6008 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6009 }
6010 else
6011 expose_frame (f,
6012 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6013 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6014 }
6015 else
6016 {
6017 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6018 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6019 #endif
6020 #if defined USE_LUCID
6021 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6022 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6023 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6024 {
6025 Widget widget
6026 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6027 if (widget)
6028 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6029 }
6030 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6031
6032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6033 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6034 goto OTHER;
6035 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6036 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6037
6038 if (bar)
6039 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6040 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6041 else
6042 goto OTHER;
6043 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6044 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6045 }
6046 break;
6047
6048 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6049 source area was obscured or not
6050 available. */
6051 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6052 if (f)
6053 {
6054 expose_frame (f,
6055 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6056 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6057 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6058 }
6059 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6060 else
6061 goto OTHER;
6062 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6063 break;
6064
6065 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6066 source area was completely
6067 available. */
6068 break;
6069
6070 case UnmapNotify:
6071 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6072 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6073 {
6074 tip_window = 0;
6075 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6076 }
6077
6078 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6079 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6080 the frame was deleted. */
6081 {
6082 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6083 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6084 display that won't ever be seen. */
6085 f->async_visible = 0;
6086 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6087 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6088 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6089 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6090 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6091 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6092 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6093 {
6094 f->async_iconified = 1;
6095
6096 bufp->kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6097 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6098 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6099 bufp++;
6100 count++;
6101 numchars--;
6102 }
6103 }
6104 goto OTHER;
6105
6106 case MapNotify:
6107 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6108 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6109 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6110 goto OTHER;
6111
6112 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6113 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6114 frame is visible. */
6115 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6116 if (f)
6117 {
6118 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
6119 the frame's display structures.
6120 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6121 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6122 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6123 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6124 if (! f->async_iconified)
6125 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6126
6127 f->async_visible = 1;
6128 f->async_iconified = 0;
6129 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6130
6131 if (f->iconified)
6132 {
6133 bufp->kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6134 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6135 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6136 bufp++;
6137 count++;
6138 numchars--;
6139 }
6140 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6141 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6142 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6143 to update the frame titles
6144 in case this is the second frame. */
6145 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6146 }
6147 goto OTHER;
6148
6149 case KeyPress:
6150
6151 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6152 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6153 if (popup_activated ())
6154 goto OTHER;
6155 #endif
6156
6157 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6158
6159 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6160 {
6161 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6162 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6163 }
6164
6165 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6166 if (f == 0)
6167 {
6168 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6169 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6170 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6171 event.xkey.window);
6172 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6173 {
6174 widget = XtParent (widget);
6175 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6176 }
6177 }
6178 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6179
6180 if (f != 0)
6181 {
6182 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6183 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6184 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6185 his Emacs hang.
6186
6187 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6188 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6189 status_return even if the input is too long to
6190 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6191 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6192 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6193 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6194 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6195 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6196 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6197 int modifiers;
6198 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6199
6200 event.xkey.state
6201 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6202 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6203 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6204
6205 /* This will have to go some day... */
6206
6207 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6208 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6209 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6210 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6211 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6212 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6213 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6214
6215 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6216 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6217 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6218 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6219 not it is combined with Meta. */
6220 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6221 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6222
6223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6224 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6225 {
6226 Status status_return;
6227
6228 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6229 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6230 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6231 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6232 &status_return);
6233 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6234 {
6235 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6236 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6237 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6238 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6239 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6240 &status_return);
6241 }
6242 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6243 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6244 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6245 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6246 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6247 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6248 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6249 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6250 &status_return);
6251 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6252 {
6253 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6254 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6255 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6256 &event.xkey,
6257 copy_bufptr,
6258 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6259 &status_return);
6260 }
6261 }
6262 #endif
6263
6264 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6265 break;
6266 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6267 {
6268 keysym = NoSymbol;
6269 modifiers = 0;
6270 }
6271 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6272 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6273 abort ();
6274 }
6275 else
6276 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6277 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6278 &compose_status);
6279 #else
6280 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6281 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6282 &compose_status);
6283 #endif
6284
6285 orig_keysym = keysym;
6286
6287 if (numchars > 1)
6288 {
6289 Lisp_Object c;
6290
6291 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6292 translations to characters. */
6293 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6294 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6295 {
6296 bufp->kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6297 bufp->code = keysym;
6298 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6299 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6300 bufp->modifiers
6301 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6302 modifiers);
6303 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6304 bufp++;
6305 count++;
6306 numchars--;
6307 }
6308 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6309 else if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6310 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6311 Vx_keysym_table,
6312 Qnil))))
6313 {
6314 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6315 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6316 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6317 bufp->code = XFASTINT (c);
6318 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6319 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6320 bufp->modifiers
6321 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6322 modifiers);
6323 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6324 bufp++;
6325 count++;
6326 numchars--;
6327 }
6328 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6329 else if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6330 || keysym == XK_Delete
6331 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6332 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6333 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6334 #endif
6335 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6336 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6337 #ifdef HPUX
6338 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6339 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6340 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6341 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6342 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6343 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6344 #endif
6345 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6346 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6347 #endif
6348 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6349 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6350 #endif
6351 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6352 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6353 #endif
6354 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6355 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6356 #endif
6357 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6358 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6359 #endif
6360 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6361 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6364 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6377 #endif
6378 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6379 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6380 #endif
6381 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6382 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6383 #endif
6384 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6385 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6386 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6387 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6388 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6389 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6390 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6391 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6392 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6393 #endif
6394 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6395 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6396 #endif
6397 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6398 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6399 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6400 don't have real modifiers but
6401 should be treated similarly to
6402 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6403 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6404 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6405 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6406 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6407 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6408 #endif
6409 ))
6410 {
6411 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short))
6412 temp_index = 0;
6413 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = keysym;
6414 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6415 key. */
6416 bufp->kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6417 bufp->code = keysym;
6418 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6419 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6420 bufp->modifiers
6421 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6422 modifiers);
6423 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6424 bufp++;
6425 count++;
6426 numchars--;
6427 }
6428 else if (numchars > nbytes)
6429 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6430 register int i;
6431 register int c;
6432 int nchars, len;
6433
6434 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6435 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6436 we used just above and the locale. */
6437 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6438 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6439 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6440 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6441 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6442 gives us composition information. */
6443 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6444
6445 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6446 {
6447 if (temp_index == (sizeof temp_buffer
6448 / sizeof (short)))
6449 temp_index = 0;
6450 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = copy_bufptr[i];
6451 }
6452
6453 {
6454 /* Decode the input data. */
6455 int require;
6456 unsigned char *p;
6457
6458 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6459 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6460 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6461 /* We explicitly disable composition
6462 handling because key data should
6463 not contain any composition
6464 sequence. */
6465 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6466 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p,
6467 nbytes, require);
6468 nbytes = coding.produced;
6469 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6470 copy_bufptr = p;
6471 }
6472
6473 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6474 character events. */
6475 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6476 {
6477 if (nchars == nbytes)
6478 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6479 else
6480 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6481 nbytes - i, len);
6482
6483 bufp->kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6484 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6485 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6486 bufp->code = c;
6487 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
6488 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6489 bufp->modifiers
6490 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6491 modifiers);
6492 bufp->timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6493 bufp++;
6494 }
6495
6496 count += nchars;
6497 numchars -= nchars;
6498
6499 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6500 break;
6501 }
6502 else
6503 abort ();
6504 }
6505 else
6506 abort ();
6507 }
6508 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6509 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6510 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6511 client. */
6512 break;
6513 #else
6514 goto OTHER;
6515 #endif
6516
6517 case KeyRelease:
6518 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6519 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6520 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6521 client. */
6522 break;
6523 #else
6524 goto OTHER;
6525 #endif
6526
6527 case EnterNotify:
6528 {
6529 int n;
6530
6531 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6532 if (n > 0)
6533 {
6534 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6535 }
6536
6537 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6538
6539 #if 0
6540 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6541 {
6542 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6543 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6544 || !(f->auto_lower)
6545 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6546 {
6547 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6548 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6549 }
6550 }
6551 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6552 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6553 #endif
6554
6555 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6556 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6557 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6558 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6559 goto OTHER;
6560 }
6561
6562 case FocusIn:
6563 {
6564 int n;
6565
6566 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6567 if (n > 0)
6568 {
6569 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6570 }
6571 }
6572
6573 goto OTHER;
6574
6575 case LeaveNotify:
6576 {
6577 int n;
6578
6579 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6580 if (n > 0)
6581 {
6582 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6583 }
6584 }
6585
6586 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6587 if (f)
6588 {
6589 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6590 {
6591 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6592 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6593 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6594 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6595 }
6596
6597 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6598 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6599 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6600 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6601 if (any_help_event_p)
6602 {
6603 Lisp_Object frame;
6604 int n;
6605
6606 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6607 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6608 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars,
6609 Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6610 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6611 }
6612
6613 }
6614 goto OTHER;
6615
6616 case FocusOut:
6617 {
6618 int n;
6619
6620 n = x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, bufp, numchars);
6621 if (n > 0)
6622 {
6623 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6624 }
6625 }
6626
6627 goto OTHER;
6628
6629 case MotionNotify:
6630 {
6631 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6632 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6633 help_echo_pos = -1;
6634
6635 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6636 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6637 f = last_mouse_frame;
6638 else
6639 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6640
6641 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6642 {
6643 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6644 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6645 }
6646
6647 if (f)
6648 {
6649
6650 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6651 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6652 {
6653 Lisp_Object window;
6654
6655 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6656 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6657 0, 0, 0, 0);
6658
6659 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6660 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6661 will be selected iff it is active. */
6662 if (WINDOWP(window)
6663 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6664 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6665 && numchars > 0)
6666 {
6667 bufp->kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6668 bufp->frame_or_window = window;
6669 bufp->arg = Qnil;
6670 ++bufp, ++count, --numchars;
6671 }
6672
6673 last_window=window;
6674 }
6675 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6676 }
6677 else
6678 {
6679 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6680 struct scroll_bar *bar
6681 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.window);
6682
6683 if (bar)
6684 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6685 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6686
6687 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6688 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6689 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6690 }
6691
6692 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6693 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6694 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6695 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6696 {
6697 Lisp_Object frame;
6698 int n;
6699
6700 if (f)
6701 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6702 else
6703 frame = Qnil;
6704
6705 any_help_event_p = 1;
6706 n = gen_help_event (bufp, numchars, help_echo_string, frame,
6707 help_echo_window, help_echo_object,
6708 help_echo_pos);
6709 bufp += n, count += n, numchars -= n;
6710 }
6711
6712 goto OTHER;
6713 }
6714
6715 case ConfigureNotify:
6716 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6717 if (f)
6718 {
6719 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6720 #ifdef USE_GTK
6721 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6722 event.xconfigure.height);
6723 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6724 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6725 do this one, the right one will come later.
6726 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6727 need to reset it below. */
6728 int dont_resize
6729 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6730 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6731 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6732 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6733
6734 if (dont_resize)
6735 goto OTHER;
6736
6737 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6738 is called by the code that handles resizing
6739 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6740
6741 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6742 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6743 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6744 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6745 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6746 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6747 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6748 {
6749 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6750 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6751 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6752 }
6753 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6754 #endif
6755
6756 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6757 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6758
6759 #ifdef USE_GTK
6760 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6761 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6762 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6763 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6764 #endif
6765 {
6766 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6767 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6768 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6769
6770 x_check_fullscreen_move (f);
6771 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6772 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6773 }
6774
6775 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6776 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6777 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6778 #endif
6779
6780 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6781 {
6782 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6783 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6784 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6785 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6786 }
6787 }
6788 goto OTHER;
6789
6790 case ButtonRelease:
6791 case ButtonPress:
6792 {
6793 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6794 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6795 struct input_event emacs_event;
6796 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6797
6798 emacs_event.kind = NO_EVENT;
6799 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6800
6801 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6802 && last_mouse_frame
6803 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6804 f = last_mouse_frame;
6805 else
6806 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6807
6808 if (f)
6809 {
6810 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6811 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6812 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6813 {
6814 Lisp_Object window;
6815 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6816 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6817
6818 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6819 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6820 {
6821 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6822 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6823 else
6824 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6825 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6826 event.xbutton.state));
6827 tool_bar_p = 1;
6828 }
6829 }
6830
6831 if (!tool_bar_p)
6832 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6833 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6834 {
6835 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6836 if (! popup_activated ())
6837 #endif
6838 construct_mouse_click (&emacs_event, &event, f);
6839 }
6840 }
6841 else
6842 {
6843 struct scroll_bar *bar
6844 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.window);
6845
6846 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6847 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6848 scroll bars. */
6849 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6850 {
6851 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
6852 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6853 }
6854 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6855 if (bar)
6856 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &emacs_event);
6857 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6858 }
6859
6860 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6861 {
6862 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6863 last_mouse_frame = f;
6864 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6865 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6866 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6867 the ButtonPress. */
6868 if (f != 0)
6869 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6870
6871 if (!tool_bar_p)
6872 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6873 }
6874 else
6875 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6876
6877 if (numchars >= 1 && emacs_event.kind != NO_EVENT)
6878 {
6879 bcopy (&emacs_event, bufp, sizeof (struct input_event));
6880 bufp++;
6881 count++;
6882 numchars--;
6883 }
6884
6885 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6886 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6887 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6888 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6889 Instead, save it away
6890 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6891 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6892 if (
6893 #ifdef USE_GTK
6894 ! popup_activated ()
6895 &&
6896 #endif
6897 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6898 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6899 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6900 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6901 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6902 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6903 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6904 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6905 {
6906 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6907 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6908 #ifdef USE_GTK
6909 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6910 #endif
6911 }
6912 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6913 {
6914 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6915 goto OTHER;
6916 }
6917
6918 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6919 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6920 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6921 {
6922 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6923 {
6924 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6925 if (f->output_data.x)
6926 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6927 }
6928 else
6929 goto OTHER;
6930 }
6931 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6932 else
6933 goto OTHER;
6934 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6935 }
6936 break;
6937
6938 case CirculateNotify:
6939 goto OTHER;
6940
6941 case CirculateRequest:
6942 goto OTHER;
6943
6944 case VisibilityNotify:
6945 goto OTHER;
6946
6947 case MappingNotify:
6948 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6949 local cache. */
6950 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6951 {
6952 case MappingModifier:
6953 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6954 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6955 case MappingKeyboard:
6956 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6957 }
6958 goto OTHER;
6959
6960 default:
6961 OTHER:
6962 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6963 BLOCK_INPUT;
6964 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6965 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6966 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6967 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6968 break;
6969 }
6970
6971 goto ret;
6972
6973 out:
6974 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6975
6976 ret:
6977 *bufp_r = bufp;
6978 *numcharsp = numchars;
6979 *eventp = event;
6980
6981 return count;
6982 }
6983
6984
6985 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6986 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6987 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6988
6989 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6990 int
6991 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6992 XEvent *event;
6993 Display *display;
6994 {
6995 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6996 struct input_event bufp[10];
6997 struct input_event *bufpp;
6998 int numchars = 10;
6999 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7000
7001 for (bufpp = bufp; bufpp != bufp + 10; bufpp++)
7002 EVENT_INIT (*bufpp);
7003 bufpp = bufp;
7004
7005 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7006 if (dpyinfo->display == display)
7007 break;
7008
7009 if (dpyinfo)
7010 {
7011 int i, events;
7012 events = handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
7013 event,
7014 &bufpp,
7015 &numchars,
7016 &finish);
7017 for (i = 0; i < events; ++i)
7018 kbd_buffer_store_event (&bufp[i]);
7019 }
7020
7021 return finish;
7022 }
7023
7024
7025 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7026 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7027 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7028
7029 Events representing keys are stored in buffer BUFP,
7030 which can hold up to NUMCHARS characters.
7031 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7032 thus pretending to be `read'.
7033
7034 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7035
7036 static int
7037 XTread_socket (sd, bufp, numchars, expected)
7038 register int sd;
7039 /* register */ struct input_event *bufp;
7040 /* register */ int numchars;
7041 int expected;
7042 {
7043 int count = 0;
7044 XEvent event;
7045 int event_found = 0;
7046 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7047
7048 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7049 {
7050 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7051 return -1;
7052 }
7053
7054 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7055 BLOCK_INPUT;
7056
7057 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7058 input_signal_count++;
7059
7060 if (numchars <= 0)
7061 abort (); /* Don't think this happens. */
7062
7063 ++handling_signal;
7064
7065 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
7066 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
7067 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
7068 {
7069 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
7070 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
7071 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
7072 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
7073 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
7074 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7075 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7076 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7077 #endif
7078
7079 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7080 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7081 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7082 for X connections. */
7083 #ifndef SIGIO
7084 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7085 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7086 {
7087 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7088 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7089 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7090 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7091 }
7092 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7093 #endif /* SIGIO */
7094 #endif
7095
7096 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7097 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7098 {
7099 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7100 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7101 }
7102
7103 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7104 BLOCK_INPUT;
7105 count += x_session_check_input (bufp, &numchars);
7106 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7107 #endif
7108
7109 #ifdef USE_GTK
7110 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7111 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7112 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7113 that is kind of ugly, but it works. */
7114 current_dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
7115
7116 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7117 {
7118 current_count = count;
7119 current_numcharsp = &numchars;
7120 current_bufp = &bufp;
7121
7122 gtk_main_iteration ();
7123
7124 count = current_count;
7125 current_bufp = 0;
7126 current_numcharsp = 0;
7127
7128 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7129 goto out;
7130 }
7131
7132 #else /* not USE_GTK */
7133 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7134 {
7135 int finish;
7136
7137 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7138
7139 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7140 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7141 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7142 break;
7143 #endif
7144 event_found = 1;
7145
7146 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo,
7147 &event,
7148 &bufp,
7149 &numchars,
7150 &finish);
7151
7152 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7153 goto out;
7154 }
7155 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7156 }
7157
7158 out:;
7159
7160 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7161 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7162 if (! event_found)
7163 {
7164 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7165 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7166 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7167 x_noop_count++;
7168 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7169 {
7170 x_noop_count=0;
7171
7172 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7173 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7174
7175 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7176
7177 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7178 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7179 }
7180 }
7181
7182 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7183 raise it now. */
7184 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7185 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7186 {
7187 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7188 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7189 }
7190
7191 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7192 --handling_signal;
7193 return count;
7194 }
7195
7196
7197
7198 \f
7199 /***********************************************************************
7200 Text Cursor
7201 ***********************************************************************/
7202
7203 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7204 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7205
7206 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7207 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7208 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7209
7210 static void
7211 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7212 struct window *w;
7213 struct glyph_row *row;
7214 GC gc;
7215 {
7216 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7217 XRectangle clip_rect;
7218 int window_y, window_width;
7219
7220 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7221
7222 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7223 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7224 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7225 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7226 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7227
7228 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7229 }
7230
7231
7232 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7233
7234 static void
7235 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7236 struct window *w;
7237 struct glyph_row *row;
7238 {
7239 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7240 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7241 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7242 int x, y, wd, h;
7243 XGCValues xgcv;
7244 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7245 GC gc;
7246
7247 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7248 coordinates. */
7249 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7250 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
7251 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
7252 h = row->height - 1;
7253
7254 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7255 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7256 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7257 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7258 return;
7259
7260 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7261 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7262 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7263 width instead. */
7264 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7265 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7266 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7267 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7268 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7269
7270 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7271 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7272 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7273 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7274 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7275 else
7276 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7277 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7278 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7279
7280 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7281 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7282 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7283 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7284 }
7285
7286
7287 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7288
7289 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7290 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7291 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7292 --gerd. */
7293
7294 static void
7295 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7296 struct window *w;
7297 struct glyph_row *row;
7298 int width;
7299 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7300 {
7301 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7302 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7303
7304 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7305 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7306 and mini-buffer. */
7307 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7308 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7309 return;
7310
7311 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7312 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7313 the bar might not be in the window. */
7314 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7315 {
7316 struct glyph_row *row;
7317 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7318 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7319 }
7320 else
7321 {
7322 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7323 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7324 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7325 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7326 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7327 XGCValues xgcv;
7328
7329 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7330 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7331 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7332 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7333 that the glyph is legible. */
7334 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7335 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7336 else
7337 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7338 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7339
7340 if (gc)
7341 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7342 else
7343 {
7344 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7345 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7346 }
7347
7348 if (width < 0)
7349 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7350 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7351
7352 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7353 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7354
7355 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7356 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7357 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7358 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7359 width, row->height);
7360 else
7361 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7362 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7363 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7364 row->height - width),
7365 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7366 width);
7367
7368 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7369 }
7370 }
7371
7372
7373 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7374
7375 static void
7376 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7377 struct frame *f;
7378 Cursor cursor;
7379 {
7380 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7381 }
7382
7383
7384 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7385
7386 static void
7387 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7388 struct frame *f;
7389 int x, y, width, height;
7390 {
7391 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7392 x, y, width, height, False);
7393 }
7394
7395
7396 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7397
7398 static void
7399 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7400 struct window *w;
7401 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7402 int x, y;
7403 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7404 int on_p, active_p;
7405 {
7406 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7407
7408 if (on_p)
7409 {
7410 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7411 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7412
7413 switch (cursor_type)
7414 {
7415 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7416 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7417 break;
7418
7419 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7420 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7421 break;
7422
7423 case BAR_CURSOR:
7424 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7425 break;
7426
7427 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7428 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7429 break;
7430
7431 case NO_CURSOR:
7432 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7433 break;
7434
7435 default:
7436 abort ();
7437 }
7438
7439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7440 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7441 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7442 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7443 #endif
7444 }
7445
7446 #ifndef XFlush
7447 if (updating_frame != f)
7448 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7449 #endif
7450 }
7451
7452 \f
7453 /* Icons. */
7454
7455 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7456
7457 int
7458 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7459 struct frame *f;
7460 Lisp_Object file;
7461 {
7462 int bitmap_id;
7463
7464 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7465 return 1;
7466
7467 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
7468 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7469 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7470 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7471
7472 if (STRINGP (file))
7473 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7474 else
7475 {
7476 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
7477 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7478 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7479 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7480 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7481
7482 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
7483 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7484 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
7485 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7486 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7487
7488 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7489 }
7490
7491 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7492 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7493
7494 return 0;
7495 }
7496
7497
7498 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7499 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7500
7501 int
7502 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7503 struct frame *f;
7504 char *icon_name;
7505 {
7506 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7507 return 1;
7508
7509 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7510 {
7511 XTextProperty text;
7512 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7513 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7514 text.format = 8;
7515 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7516 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7517 }
7518 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7519 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7520 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7521
7522 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7523 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7524 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7525 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7526
7527 return 0;
7528 }
7529 \f
7530 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7531
7532 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7533 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7534
7535 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7536
7537 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7538 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7539 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7540
7541 static void
7542 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7543 Display *display;
7544 XErrorEvent *error;
7545 {
7546 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7547 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7548 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7549 }
7550
7551 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7552 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7553 operating on.
7554
7555 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7556 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7557 stored in x_error_message_string.
7558
7559 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7560 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7561
7562 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7563
7564 void x_check_errors ();
7565 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7566
7567 int
7568 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7569 Display *dpy;
7570 {
7571 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7572
7573 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7574 XSync (dpy, False);
7575
7576 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7577 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7578 x_error_message_string));
7579
7580 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7581 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7582
7583 return count;
7584 }
7585
7586 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7587
7588 static Lisp_Object
7589 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7590 Lisp_Object old_val;
7591 {
7592 Lisp_Object first;
7593
7594 first = XCAR (old_val);
7595
7596 XSync (XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer, False);
7597
7598 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7599 return Qnil;
7600 }
7601
7602 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7603 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7604 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7605
7606 void
7607 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7608 Display *dpy;
7609 char *format;
7610 {
7611 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7612 XSync (dpy, False);
7613
7614 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7615 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7616 }
7617
7618 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7619 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7620
7621 int
7622 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7623 Display *dpy;
7624 {
7625 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7626 XSync (dpy, False);
7627
7628 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7629 }
7630
7631 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7632
7633 void
7634 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7635 Display *dpy;
7636 {
7637 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7638 }
7639
7640 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7641 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7642 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7643 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7644
7645 void
7646 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7647 Display *dpy;
7648 int count;
7649 {
7650 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7651 }
7652
7653 #if 0
7654 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7655 x_trace_wire ()
7656 {
7657 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7658 }
7659 #endif /* ! 0 */
7660
7661 \f
7662 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7663 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7664 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7665 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7666 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7667
7668 static SIGTYPE
7669 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7670 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7671 {
7672 #ifdef USG
7673 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7674 must reestablish each time */
7675 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7676 #endif /* USG */
7677 }
7678
7679 \f
7680 /************************************************************************
7681 Handling X errors
7682 ************************************************************************/
7683
7684 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7685
7686 static char *error_msg;
7687
7688 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7689 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7690 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7691
7692 static void
7693 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7694 {
7695 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7696 exit (70);
7697 }
7698
7699 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7700 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7701
7702 static SIGTYPE
7703 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7704 Display *dpy;
7705 char *error_message;
7706 {
7707 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7708 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7709 int count;
7710
7711 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7712 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7713 handling_signal = 0;
7714
7715 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7716 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7717 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7718 the original message here. */
7719 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7720
7721 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7722 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7723 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7724
7725 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7726 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7727 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7728
7729 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7730 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7731
7732 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7733 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7734 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7735
7736 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7737 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7738 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7739 if (dpyinfo)
7740 {
7741 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7742 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7743 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7744 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7745 }
7746 #endif
7747
7748 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7749 if (dpyinfo)
7750 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7751
7752 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7753 that are on the dead display. */
7754 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7755 {
7756 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7757 minibuf_frame
7758 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7759 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7760 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7761 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7762 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7763 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7764 }
7765
7766 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7767 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7768 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7769 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7770 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7771 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7772 {
7773 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7774 trying to find a replacement. */
7775 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7776 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7777 }
7778
7779 if (dpyinfo)
7780 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7781
7782 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7783
7784 if (x_display_list == 0)
7785 {
7786 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7787 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7788 exit (70);
7789 }
7790
7791 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7792 #ifdef SIGIO
7793 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7794 #endif
7795 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7796 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7797
7798 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7799 error ("%s", error_msg);
7800 }
7801
7802
7803 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7804 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7805 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7806
7807 static void
7808 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7809 Display *display;
7810 XErrorEvent *error;
7811 {
7812 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7813
7814 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7815 original error handler. */
7816
7817 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7818 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7819 buf, error->request_code);
7820 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7821 }
7822
7823
7824 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7825 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7826
7827 static int
7828 x_error_handler (display, error)
7829 Display *display;
7830 XErrorEvent *error;
7831 {
7832 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7833 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7834 else
7835 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7836 return 0;
7837 }
7838
7839 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7840 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7841 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7842
7843 static int
7844 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7845 Display *display;
7846 {
7847 char buf[256];
7848
7849 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7850 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7851 return 0;
7852 }
7853 \f
7854 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7855
7856 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7857 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7858 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7859 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7860
7861 Lisp_Object
7862 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7863 struct frame *f;
7864 register char *fontname;
7865 {
7866 struct font_info *fontp
7867 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7868
7869 if (!fontp)
7870 return Qnil;
7871
7872 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7873 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7874 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7875
7876 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7877 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7878
7879 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7880
7881 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7882 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7883 {
7884 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7885 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7886 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7887 }
7888 else
7889 {
7890 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7891 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7892 }
7893
7894 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7895 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7896 {
7897 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7898 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7899 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7900 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7901 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7902 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7903
7904 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7905 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7906 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7907 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7908 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7909 }
7910
7911 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7912 }
7913
7914 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7915 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7916 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7917 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7918
7919 Lisp_Object
7920 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7921 struct frame *f;
7922 char *fontsetname;
7923 {
7924 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7925 Lisp_Object result;
7926
7927 if (fontset < 0)
7928 return Qnil;
7929
7930 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7931 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7932 to do. */
7933 return fontset_name (fontset);
7934
7935 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7936
7937 if (!STRINGP (result))
7938 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7939 return Qnil;
7940
7941 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7942 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7943
7944 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7945 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7946 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7947 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7948 #endif
7949
7950 return build_string (fontsetname);
7951 }
7952
7953 \f
7954 /***********************************************************************
7955 X Input Methods
7956 ***********************************************************************/
7957
7958 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7959
7960 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7961
7962 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7963 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7964 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7965
7966 static void
7967 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7968 XIM xim;
7969 XPointer client_data;
7970 XPointer call_data;
7971 {
7972 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7973 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7974
7975 BLOCK_INPUT;
7976
7977 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7978 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7979 {
7980 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7981 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7982 {
7983 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7984 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
7985 {
7986 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
7987 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
7988 }
7989 }
7990 }
7991
7992 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7993 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7994 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7995 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7996 }
7997
7998 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7999
8000 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8001 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8002 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8003 #endif
8004
8005 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8006 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8007
8008 static void
8009 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8010 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8011 char *resource_name;
8012 {
8013 XIM xim;
8014
8015 if (use_xim)
8016 {
8017 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8018 EMACS_CLASS);
8019 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8020
8021 if (xim)
8022 {
8023 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8024 XIMCallback destroy;
8025 #endif
8026
8027 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8028 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8029
8030 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8031 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8032 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8033 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8034 #endif
8035 }
8036 }
8037
8038 else
8039 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8040 }
8041
8042
8043 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8044
8045 struct xim_inst_t
8046 {
8047 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8048 char *resource_name;
8049 };
8050
8051 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8052 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8053 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8054 when the callback was registered. */
8055
8056 static void
8057 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8058 Display *display;
8059 XPointer client_data;
8060 XPointer call_data;
8061 {
8062 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8063 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8064
8065 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8066 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8067 return;
8068
8069 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8070
8071 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8072 as they have no XIC. */
8073 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8074 {
8075 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8076
8077 BLOCK_INPUT;
8078 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8079 {
8080 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8081
8082 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8083 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8084 {
8085 create_frame_xic (f);
8086 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8087 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8088 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8089 {
8090 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8091 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8092 }
8093 }
8094 }
8095
8096 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8097 }
8098 }
8099
8100 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8101
8102
8103 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8104 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8105 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8106 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8107
8108 static void
8109 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8110 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8111 char *resource_name;
8112 {
8113 if (use_xim)
8114 {
8115 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8116 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8117 int len;
8118
8119 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8120 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8121 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8122 len = strlen (resource_name);
8123 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8124 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8125 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8126 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8127 xim_instantiate_callback,
8128 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8129 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8130 least, hence the configure test. */
8131 (XPointer) xim_inst);
8132 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8133 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8134 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8135 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8136
8137 }
8138 else
8139 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8140 }
8141
8142
8143 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8144
8145 static void
8146 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8147 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8148 {
8149 if (use_xim)
8150 {
8151 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8152 if (dpyinfo->display)
8153 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8154 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8155 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8156 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8157 if (dpyinfo->display)
8158 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8159 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8160 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8161 }
8162 }
8163
8164 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8165
8166
8167 \f
8168 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8169 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8170
8171 void
8172 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8173 struct frame *f;
8174 {
8175 Window child;
8176 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8177 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8178 int this_window;
8179
8180 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8181 is already for the top-left corner. */
8182 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8183 return;
8184
8185 this_window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8186
8187 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
8188 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8189 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8190 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8191 {
8192 int count;
8193
8194 BLOCK_INPUT;
8195 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8196 while (1)
8197 {
8198 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8199 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8200
8201 /* From-window, to-window. */
8202 this_window,
8203 f->output_data.x->parent_desc,
8204
8205 /* From-position, to-position. */
8206 0, 0, &win_x, &win_y,
8207
8208 /* Child of win. */
8209 &child);
8210 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
8211 {
8212 Window newroot, newparent = 0xdeadbeef;
8213 Window *newchildren;
8214 unsigned int nchildren;
8215
8216 if (! XQueryTree (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), this_window, &newroot,
8217 &newparent, &newchildren, &nchildren))
8218 break;
8219
8220 XFree ((char *) newchildren);
8221
8222 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = newparent;
8223 }
8224 else
8225 break;
8226 }
8227
8228 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
8229 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8230 }
8231
8232 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8233 position that fits on the screen. */
8234 if (flags & XNegative)
8235 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8236 - 2 * f->border_width - win_x
8237 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8238 + f->left_pos);
8239
8240 {
8241 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8242
8243 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8244 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8245 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8246
8247 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8248 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8249 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8250 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8251 is right, though.
8252
8253 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8254 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8255
8256 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8257 #endif
8258
8259 if (flags & YNegative)
8260 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8261 - 2 * f->border_width
8262 - win_y
8263 - height
8264 + f->top_pos);
8265 }
8266
8267 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8268 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8269 so the flags should correspond. */
8270 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8271 }
8272
8273 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8274 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8275 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8276 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8277 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8278
8279 void
8280 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8281 struct frame *f;
8282 register int xoff, yoff;
8283 int change_gravity;
8284 {
8285 int modified_top, modified_left;
8286
8287 if (change_gravity > 0)
8288 {
8289 f->top_pos = yoff;
8290 f->left_pos = xoff;
8291 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8292 if (xoff < 0)
8293 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8294 if (yoff < 0)
8295 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8296 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8297 }
8298 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8299
8300 BLOCK_INPUT;
8301 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8302
8303 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8304 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8305 #if 0 /* Running on psilocin (Debian), and displaying on the NCD X-terminal,
8306 this seems to be unnecessary and incorrect. rms, 4/17/97. */
8307 /* It is a mystery why we need to add the border_width here
8308 when the frame is already visible, but experiment says we do. */
8309 if (change_gravity != 0)
8310 {
8311 modified_left += f->border_width;
8312 modified_top += f->border_width;
8313 }
8314 #endif
8315
8316 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8317 modified_left, modified_top);
8318 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8319 }
8320
8321 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8322 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8323 static void
8324 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8325 struct frame *f;
8326 {
8327 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8328 {
8329 int width, height, ign;
8330
8331 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8332
8333 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8334
8335 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8336 when setting WM manager hints.
8337 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8338 x_check_fullscreen_move. */
8339 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8340 {
8341 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8342 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8343 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8344
8345 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8346 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8347 }
8348 }
8349 }
8350
8351 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8352 the window. This is done in xfns.c.
8353 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8354 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8355 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8356 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8357 static void
8358 x_check_fullscreen_move (f)
8359 struct frame *f;
8360 {
8361 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT)
8362 {
8363 int expect_top = f->top_pos;
8364 int expect_left = f->left_pos;
8365
8366 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8367 expect_top = 0;
8368 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8369 expect_left = 0;
8370
8371 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8372 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8373
8374 /* Just do this once */
8375 f->want_fullscreen &= ~FULLSCREEN_MOVE_WAIT;
8376 }
8377 }
8378
8379
8380 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8381 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8382 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8383 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8384
8385 static void
8386 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8387 struct frame *f;
8388 int change_gravity;
8389 int cols, rows;
8390 {
8391 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8392
8393 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8394 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8395 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8396 ? 0
8397 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8398 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8399 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8400
8401 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8402
8403 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8404 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8405
8406 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8407 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8408
8409 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8410 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8411 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8412
8413 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8414 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8415 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8416 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8417
8418 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8419 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8420 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8421 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8422 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8423
8424 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8425 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8426 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8427 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8428 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8429
8430 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8431 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8432 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8433 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8434 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8435
8436 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8437 }
8438
8439
8440 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8441 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8442 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8443 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8444
8445 void
8446 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8447 struct frame *f;
8448 int change_gravity;
8449 int cols, rows;
8450 {
8451 BLOCK_INPUT;
8452
8453 #ifdef USE_GTK
8454 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8455 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8456 else
8457 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8458 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8459
8460 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8461 {
8462 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8463 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8464 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8465 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8466 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8467 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8468 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8469 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8470 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8471 }
8472 else
8473 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8474
8475 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8476
8477 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8478
8479 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8480
8481 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8482 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8483
8484 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8485 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8486 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8487 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8488 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8489
8490 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8491 }
8492 \f
8493 /* Mouse warping. */
8494
8495 void
8496 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8497 struct frame *f;
8498 int x, y;
8499 {
8500 int pix_x, pix_y;
8501
8502 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8503 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8504
8505 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8506 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8507
8508 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8509 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8510
8511 BLOCK_INPUT;
8512
8513 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8514 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8515 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8516 }
8517
8518 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8519
8520 void
8521 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8522 struct frame *f;
8523 int pix_x, pix_y;
8524 {
8525 BLOCK_INPUT;
8526
8527 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8528 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8529 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8530 }
8531 \f
8532 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8533
8534 void
8535 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8536 struct frame *f;
8537 {
8538 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8539 x_raise_frame (f);
8540 #endif
8541 #if 0
8542 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8543 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8544 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8545 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8546 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8547 #endif /* ! 0 */
8548 }
8549
8550 void
8551 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8552 struct frame *f;
8553 {
8554 #if 0
8555 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8556 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8557 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8558 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8559 #endif /* ! 0 */
8560 }
8561
8562 /* Raise frame F. */
8563
8564 void
8565 x_raise_frame (f)
8566 struct frame *f;
8567 {
8568 if (f->async_visible)
8569 {
8570 BLOCK_INPUT;
8571 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8572 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8573 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8574 }
8575 }
8576
8577 /* Lower frame F. */
8578
8579 void
8580 x_lower_frame (f)
8581 struct frame *f;
8582 {
8583 if (f->async_visible)
8584 {
8585 BLOCK_INPUT;
8586 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8587 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8588 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8589 }
8590 }
8591
8592 static void
8593 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8594 FRAME_PTR f;
8595 int raise_flag;
8596 {
8597 if (raise_flag)
8598 x_raise_frame (f);
8599 else
8600 x_lower_frame (f);
8601 }
8602 \f
8603 /* Change of visibility. */
8604
8605 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8606 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8607 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8608 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8609 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8610 finishes with it. */
8611
8612 void
8613 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8614 struct frame *f;
8615 {
8616 Lisp_Object type;
8617 int original_top, original_left;
8618 int retry_count = 2;
8619
8620 retry:
8621
8622 BLOCK_INPUT;
8623
8624 type = x_icon_type (f);
8625 if (!NILP (type))
8626 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8627
8628 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8629 {
8630 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8631 call x_set_offset a second time
8632 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8633 before the window gets really visible. */
8634 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8635 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8636 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8637
8638 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8639
8640 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8641 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8642 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8643 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8644 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8645 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8646 #ifdef USE_GTK
8647 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8648 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8649 #else
8650 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8651 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8652 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8653 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8654 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8655 to come back ok without this. */
8656 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8657 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8658 #endif
8659 }
8660
8661 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8662
8663 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8664 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8665 so that incoming events are handled. */
8666 {
8667 Lisp_Object frame;
8668 int count;
8669 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8670 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8671 will set it when they are handled. */
8672 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8673
8674 original_left = f->left_pos;
8675 original_top = f->top_pos;
8676
8677 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8678 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8679
8680 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8681
8682 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8683 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8684 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8685 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8686
8687 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8688 because the window manager may choose the position
8689 and we don't want to override it. */
8690
8691 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8692 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8693 && previously_visible)
8694 {
8695 Drawable rootw;
8696 int x, y;
8697 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8698
8699 BLOCK_INPUT;
8700
8701 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8702 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8703 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8704 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8705 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8706 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8707 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8708 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8709 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8710
8711 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8712 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8713 original_left, original_top);
8714
8715 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8716 }
8717
8718 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8719
8720 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8721 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8722 MapNotify at all.. */
8723 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8724 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8725 {
8726 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8727 x_sync (f);
8728
8729 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8730 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8731 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8732 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8733 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8734 probably a bug. */
8735 if (input_polling_used ())
8736 {
8737 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8738 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8739 handler reset it. */
8740 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8741 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8742 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8743 poll_for_input_1 ();
8744 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8745 }
8746
8747 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8748 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8749 }
8750
8751 /* 2000-09-28: In
8752
8753 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8754 (iconify-frame f)
8755 (raise-frame f))
8756
8757 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8758 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8759 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8760 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8761
8762 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8763 goto retry;
8764 }
8765 }
8766
8767 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8768
8769 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8770
8771 void
8772 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8773 struct frame *f;
8774 {
8775 Window window;
8776
8777 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8778 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8779
8780 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8781 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8782 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8783
8784 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8785 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8786 return;
8787 #endif
8788
8789 BLOCK_INPUT;
8790
8791 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8792 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8793 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8794 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8795 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8796 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8797
8798 #ifdef USE_GTK
8799 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8800 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8801 else
8802 #endif
8803 {
8804 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8805
8806 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8807 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8808 {
8809 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8810 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8811 }
8812 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8813
8814 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8815 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8816 {
8817 XEvent unmap;
8818
8819 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8820 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8821 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8822 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8823 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8824 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8825 False,
8826 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8827 &unmap))
8828 {
8829 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8830 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8831 }
8832 }
8833
8834 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8835 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8836 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8837 }
8838
8839 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8840 just by the event that we get from the server.
8841 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8842 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8843 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8844 f->visible = 0;
8845 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8846 f->async_visible = 0;
8847 f->async_iconified = 0;
8848
8849 x_sync (f);
8850
8851 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8852 }
8853
8854 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8855
8856 void
8857 x_iconify_frame (f)
8858 struct frame *f;
8859 {
8860 int result;
8861 Lisp_Object type;
8862
8863 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8864 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8865 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8866
8867 if (f->async_iconified)
8868 return;
8869
8870 BLOCK_INPUT;
8871
8872 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8873
8874 type = x_icon_type (f);
8875 if (!NILP (type))
8876 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8877
8878 #ifdef USE_GTK
8879 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8880 {
8881 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8882 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8883
8884 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8885 f->iconified = 1;
8886 f->visible = 1;
8887 f->async_iconified = 1;
8888 f->async_visible = 0;
8889 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8890 return;
8891 }
8892 #endif
8893
8894 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8895
8896 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8897 {
8898 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8899 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8900 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8901 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8902 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8903 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8904 so we have to record it here. */
8905 f->iconified = 1;
8906 f->visible = 1;
8907 f->async_iconified = 1;
8908 f->async_visible = 0;
8909 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8910 return;
8911 }
8912
8913 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8914 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8915 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8916 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8917
8918 if (!result)
8919 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8920
8921 f->async_iconified = 1;
8922 f->async_visible = 0;
8923
8924
8925 BLOCK_INPUT;
8926 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8927 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8928 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8929
8930 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8931 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8932 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8933 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8934
8935 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8936 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8937
8938 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8939 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8940 {
8941 XEvent message;
8942
8943 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8944 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8945 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8946 message.xclient.format = 32;
8947 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8948
8949 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8950 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8951 False,
8952 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8953 &message))
8954 {
8955 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8956 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8957 }
8958 }
8959
8960 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8961 IconicState. */
8962 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8963
8964 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8965 {
8966 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8967 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8968 }
8969
8970 f->async_iconified = 1;
8971 f->async_visible = 0;
8972
8973 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8974 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8975 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8976 }
8977
8978 \f
8979 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8980
8981 void
8982 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8983 struct frame *f;
8984 {
8985 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8986 Lisp_Object bar;
8987 struct scroll_bar *b;
8988
8989 BLOCK_INPUT;
8990
8991 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8992 commands to the X server. */
8993 if (dpyinfo->display)
8994 {
8995 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8996 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8997
8998 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8999 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9000 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9001 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9002 toolkit scroll bars. */
9003 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9004 {
9005 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9006 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9007 }
9008 #endif
9009
9010 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9011 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9012 free_frame_xic (f);
9013 #endif
9014
9015 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9016 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9017 {
9018 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9019 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9020 }
9021 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9022 we are using a toolkit. */
9023 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9024 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9025
9026 free_frame_menubar (f);
9027 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9028
9029 #ifdef USE_GTK
9030 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9031 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9032 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9033 {
9034 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9035 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9036 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9037 }
9038 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9039
9040 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9041 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9042 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9043
9044 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9045 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9046 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9047 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9048 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9049 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9050
9051 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9052 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9053 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9054 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9055 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9056 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9057 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9058 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9059 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9060 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9061 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9062 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9063 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9064 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9065 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9066
9067 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9068 free_frame_faces (f);
9069
9070 x_free_gcs (f);
9071 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9072 }
9073
9074 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9075 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9076
9077 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9078 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9079
9080 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9081 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9082 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9083 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9084 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9085 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9086
9087 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9088 {
9089 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9090 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9091 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9092 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9093 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9094 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9095 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9096 }
9097
9098 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9099 }
9100
9101
9102 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9103
9104 void
9105 x_destroy_window (f)
9106 struct frame *f;
9107 {
9108 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9109
9110 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9111 commands to the X server. */
9112 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9113 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9114
9115 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9116 }
9117
9118 \f
9119 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9120
9121 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9122 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9123 that the window now has.
9124 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9125 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9126 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9127
9128 #ifndef USE_GTK
9129 void
9130 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9131 struct frame *f;
9132 long flags;
9133 int user_position;
9134 {
9135 XSizeHints size_hints;
9136
9137 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9138 Arg al[2];
9139 int ac = 0;
9140 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9141 #endif
9142
9143 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9144
9145 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9146 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9147
9148 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9149 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9150
9151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9152 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9153 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9154 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9155 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9156 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9157 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9158 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9159 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9160 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9161
9162 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9163 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9164 size_hints.max_width
9165 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9166 size_hints.max_height
9167 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9168
9169 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9170
9171 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9172 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9173 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9174 {
9175 int base_width, base_height;
9176 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9177
9178 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9179 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9180
9181 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9182
9183 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9184 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9185 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9186 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9187 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9188
9189 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9190 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9191 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9192
9193 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9194 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9195 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9196 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9197 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9198 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9199 #else
9200 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9201 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9202 #endif
9203 }
9204
9205 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9206 if (flags)
9207 {
9208 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9209 goto no_read;
9210 }
9211 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9212
9213 {
9214 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9215 long supplied_return;
9216 int value;
9217
9218 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9219 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9220 &supplied_return);
9221 #else
9222 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9223 #endif
9224
9225 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9226 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9227 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9228 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9229 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9230 #endif
9231
9232 if (flags)
9233 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9234 else
9235 {
9236 if (value == 0)
9237 hints.flags = 0;
9238 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9239 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9240 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9241 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9242 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9243 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9244 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9245 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9246 }
9247 }
9248
9249 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9250 no_read:
9251 #endif
9252
9253 #ifdef PWinGravity
9254 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9255 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9256
9257 if (user_position)
9258 {
9259 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9260 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9261 }
9262 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9263
9264 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9265 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9266 #else
9267 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9268 #endif
9269 }
9270 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9271
9272 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9273
9274 void
9275 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9276 struct frame *f;
9277 int state;
9278 {
9279 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9280 Arg al[1];
9281
9282 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9283 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9284 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9285 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9286
9287 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9288 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9289
9290 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9291 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9292 }
9293
9294 void
9295 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9296 struct frame *f;
9297 int pixmap_id;
9298 {
9299 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
9300
9301 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9302 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9303 #endif
9304
9305 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9306 {
9307 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9308 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9309 }
9310 else
9311 {
9312 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9313 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9314 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9315 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9316 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9317 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9318 best to explicitly give up. */
9319 #if 0
9320 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9321 #else
9322 return;
9323 #endif
9324 }
9325
9326 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9327
9328 {
9329 Arg al[1];
9330 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9331 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9332 }
9333
9334 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9335
9336 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
9337 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9338
9339 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9340 }
9341
9342 void
9343 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9344 struct frame *f;
9345 int icon_x, icon_y;
9346 {
9347 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9348
9349 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9350 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9351 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9352
9353 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9354 }
9355
9356 \f
9357 /***********************************************************************
9358 Fonts
9359 ***********************************************************************/
9360
9361 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9362
9363 struct font_info *
9364 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9365 FRAME_PTR f;
9366 int font_idx;
9367 {
9368 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9369 }
9370
9371
9372 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9373
9374 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9375 to be listed.
9376
9377 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9378
9379 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9380 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9381 on how many fonts to match. */
9382
9383 Lisp_Object
9384 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9385 struct frame *f;
9386 Lisp_Object pattern;
9387 int size;
9388 int maxnames;
9389 {
9390 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9391 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9392 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9393 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9394 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9395 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9396 int count;
9397 int allow_scalable_fonts_p = 0;
9398
9399 if (size < 0)
9400 {
9401 allow_scalable_fonts_p = 1;
9402 size = 0;
9403 }
9404
9405 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9406 if (NILP (patterns))
9407 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9408
9409 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9410 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9411 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9412
9413 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9414 {
9415 int num_fonts;
9416 char **names = NULL;
9417
9418 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9419 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9420 The cache is an alist of the form:
9421 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9422 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9423 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9424 allow_scalable_fonts_p ? Qt : Qnil);
9425 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9426 if (!NILP (list))
9427 {
9428 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9429 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9430 goto label_cached;
9431 }
9432
9433 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9434
9435 BLOCK_INPUT;
9436 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9437
9438 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9439 {
9440 XFontStruct *font;
9441 unsigned long value;
9442
9443 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9444 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9445 {
9446 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9447 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9448 font = NULL;
9449 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9450 }
9451
9452 if (font
9453 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9454 {
9455 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9456 int len = strlen (name);
9457 char *tmp;
9458
9459 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9460 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9461 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9462 if (len == 0)
9463 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9464 else
9465 {
9466 num_fonts = 1;
9467 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9468 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9469 simple var. */
9470 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9471 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9472 XFree (name);
9473 }
9474 }
9475 else
9476 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9477
9478 if (font)
9479 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9480 }
9481
9482 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9483 {
9484 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9485 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9486 if (maxnames < 0)
9487 {
9488 int limit;
9489
9490 for (limit = 500;;)
9491 {
9492 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9493 if (num_fonts == limit)
9494 {
9495 BLOCK_INPUT;
9496 XFreeFontNames (names);
9497 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9498 limit *= 2;
9499 }
9500 else
9501 break;
9502 }
9503 }
9504 else
9505 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9506 &num_fonts);
9507
9508 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9509 {
9510 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9511 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9512 names = NULL;
9513 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9514 }
9515 }
9516
9517 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9518 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9519
9520 if (names)
9521 {
9522 int i;
9523
9524 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9525 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9526 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9527 {
9528 int width = 0;
9529 char *p = names[i];
9530 int average_width = -1, dashes = 0;
9531
9532 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9533 14 dashes, and the field value following 12th dash
9534 (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a auto-scaled font which
9535 is usually too ugly to be used for editing. Let's
9536 ignore it. */
9537 while (*p)
9538 if (*p++ == '-')
9539 {
9540 dashes++;
9541 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9542 width = atoi (p);
9543 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9544 average_width = atoi (p);
9545 }
9546
9547 if (allow_scalable_fonts_p
9548 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0)
9549 {
9550 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9551 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9552 {
9553 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9554 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9555 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9556 >= 0))
9557 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9558 width of this font. */
9559 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9560 else
9561 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9562 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9563 }
9564 }
9565 }
9566
9567 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9568 {
9569 BLOCK_INPUT;
9570 XFreeFontNames (names);
9571 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9572 }
9573 }
9574
9575 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9576 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9577 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9578
9579 label_cached:
9580 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9581
9582 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9583 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9584 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9585 {
9586 int found_size;
9587
9588 tem = XCAR (list);
9589
9590 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9591 continue;
9592 if (!size)
9593 {
9594 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9595 continue;
9596 }
9597
9598 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9599 {
9600 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9601 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9602 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9603
9604 BLOCK_INPUT;
9605 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9606 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9607 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9608 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9609 {
9610 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9611 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9612 thisinfo = NULL;
9613 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9614 }
9615 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9616 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9617
9618 if (thisinfo)
9619 {
9620 XSETCDR (tem,
9621 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9622 ? make_number (0)
9623 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9624 BLOCK_INPUT;
9625 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9626 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9627 }
9628 else
9629 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9630 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9631 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9632 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9633 }
9634
9635 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9636 if (found_size == size)
9637 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9638 else if (found_size > 0)
9639 {
9640 if (NILP (second_best))
9641 second_best = tem;
9642 else if (found_size < size)
9643 {
9644 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9645 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9646 second_best = tem;
9647 }
9648 else
9649 {
9650 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9651 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9652 second_best = tem;
9653 }
9654 }
9655 }
9656 if (!NILP (newlist))
9657 break;
9658 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9659 {
9660 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9661 break;
9662 }
9663 }
9664
9665 return newlist;
9666 }
9667
9668
9669 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9670
9671 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9672 font table. */
9673
9674 static void
9675 x_check_font (f, font)
9676 struct frame *f;
9677 XFontStruct *font;
9678 {
9679 int i;
9680 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9681
9682 xassert (font != NULL);
9683
9684 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9685 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9686 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9687 break;
9688
9689 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9690 }
9691
9692 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9693
9694 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9695 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9696 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9697 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9698 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9699
9700 static INLINE void
9701 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9702 XFontStruct *font;
9703 int *w, *h;
9704 {
9705 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9706 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9707
9708 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9709 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9710 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9711 if (*w <= 0)
9712 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9713 }
9714
9715
9716 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9717 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9718 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9719 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9720 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9721
9722 static int
9723 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9724 struct frame *f;
9725 {
9726 int i;
9727 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9728 XFontStruct *font;
9729 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9730 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9731
9732 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9733 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9734
9735 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9736 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9737 {
9738 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9739 int w, h;
9740
9741 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9742 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9743 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9744
9745 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9746 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9747 }
9748
9749 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9750 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9751
9752 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9753 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9754 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9755 }
9756
9757
9758 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9759 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9760 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9761 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9762
9763 struct font_info *
9764 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9765 struct frame *f;
9766 register char *fontname;
9767 int size;
9768 {
9769 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9770 Lisp_Object font_names;
9771 int count;
9772
9773 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9774 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9775 we already have by comparing names. */
9776 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9777
9778 if (!NILP (font_names))
9779 {
9780 Lisp_Object tail;
9781 int i;
9782
9783 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9784 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9785 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9786 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9787 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9788 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9789 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9790 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9791 }
9792
9793 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9794 {
9795 char *full_name;
9796 XFontStruct *font;
9797 struct font_info *fontp;
9798 unsigned long value;
9799 int i;
9800
9801 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9802 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9803 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9804 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9805 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9806 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9807 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9808
9809 BLOCK_INPUT;
9810 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9811 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9812 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9813 {
9814 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9815 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9816 font = NULL;
9817 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9818 }
9819 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9820 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9821 if (!font)
9822 return NULL;
9823
9824 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9825 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9826 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9827 break;
9828
9829 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9830 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9831 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9832 {
9833 int sz;
9834 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9835 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9836 dpyinfo->font_table
9837 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9838 }
9839
9840 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9841 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9842 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9843
9844 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9845 BLOCK_INPUT;
9846 fontp->font = font;
9847 fontp->font_idx = i;
9848 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9849 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9850
9851 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9852 full_name = 0;
9853 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9854 {
9855 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9856 char *p = name;
9857 int dashes = 0;
9858
9859 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9860 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9861 so don't use it.
9862 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9863 stored in them. */
9864 while (*p)
9865 {
9866 if (*p == '-')
9867 dashes++;
9868 p++;
9869 }
9870
9871 if (dashes >= 13)
9872 {
9873 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9874 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9875 }
9876
9877 XFree (name);
9878 }
9879
9880 if (full_name != 0)
9881 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9882 else
9883 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9884
9885 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9886 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9887
9888 if (NILP (font_names))
9889 {
9890 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9891 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9892 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9893 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9894 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9895 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9896 Qnil);
9897
9898 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9899 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9900 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9901 make_number (fontp->size)),
9902 Qnil)),
9903 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9904 if (full_name)
9905 {
9906 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9907 Qnil);
9908 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9909 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9910 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9911 make_number (fontp->size)),
9912 Qnil)),
9913 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9914 }
9915 }
9916
9917 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9918 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9919 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9920 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9921 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9922 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9923 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9924 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9925 fontp->encoding[1]
9926 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9927 /* 1-byte font */
9928 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9929 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9930 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9931 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9932 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9933 /* 2-byte font */
9934 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9935 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9936 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9937 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9938 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9939 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9940 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9941 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9942 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9943 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9944 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9945 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9946 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9947
9948 fontp->baseline_offset
9949 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9950 ? (long) value : 0);
9951 fontp->relative_compose
9952 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9953 ? (long) value : 0);
9954 fontp->default_ascent
9955 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9956 ? (long) value : 0);
9957
9958 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9959 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9960 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9961 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9962 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9963 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9964 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9965 return fontp;
9966 }
9967 }
9968
9969
9970 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9971 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9972
9973 struct font_info *
9974 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9975 struct frame *f;
9976 register char *fontname;
9977 {
9978 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9979 int i;
9980
9981 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9982 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9983 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9984 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9985 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9986 return NULL;
9987 }
9988
9989
9990 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9991 `encoder' of the structure. */
9992
9993 void
9994 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9995 struct font_info *fontp;
9996 {
9997 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9998
9999 elt = Qnil;
10000 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10001 {
10002 elt = XCAR (list);
10003 if (CONSP (elt)
10004 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10005 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10006 >= 0)
10007 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10008 >= 0)))
10009 break;
10010 }
10011
10012 if (! NILP (list))
10013 {
10014 struct ccl_program *ccl
10015 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10016
10017 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10018 xfree (ccl);
10019 else
10020 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10021 }
10022 }
10023
10024
10025 \f
10026 /***********************************************************************
10027 Initialization
10028 ***********************************************************************/
10029
10030 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10031 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10032 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10033 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10034
10035 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10036 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10037 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10038
10039 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10040 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10041 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10042 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10043 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10044 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10045 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10046 };
10047 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10048
10049 static int x_initialized;
10050
10051 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10052 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10053 the screen number from the server number. */
10054 static int
10055 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10056 const char *name1, *name2;
10057 {
10058 int seen_colon = 0;
10059 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10060 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10061 int length_until_period = 0;
10062
10063 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10064 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10065 length_until_period++;
10066
10067 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10068 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10069 name1 += 4;
10070 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10071 name2 += 4;
10072 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10073 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10074 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10075 name1 += system_name_length;
10076 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10077 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10078 name2 += system_name_length;
10079 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10080 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10081 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10082 name1 += length_until_period;
10083 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10084 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10085 name2 += length_until_period;
10086
10087 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10088 {
10089 if (*name1 == ':')
10090 seen_colon++;
10091 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10092 return 1;
10093 }
10094 return (seen_colon
10095 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10096 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10097 }
10098 #endif
10099
10100 struct x_display_info *
10101 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10102 Lisp_Object display_name;
10103 char *xrm_option;
10104 char *resource_name;
10105 {
10106 int connection;
10107 Display *dpy;
10108 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10109 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10110
10111 BLOCK_INPUT;
10112
10113 if (!x_initialized)
10114 {
10115 x_initialize ();
10116 x_initialized = 1;
10117 }
10118
10119 #ifdef USE_GTK
10120 {
10121 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10122 int argc;
10123 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10124 char **argv2 = argv;
10125 GdkAtom atom;
10126
10127 /* GTK 2.0 can only handle one display, GTK 2.2 can handle more
10128 than one, but this remains to be implemented. */
10129 if (x_initialized > 1)
10130 return 0;
10131
10132 x_initialized++;
10133
10134 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10135 argv[argc] = 0;
10136
10137 argc = 0;
10138 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10139
10140 if (! NILP (display_name))
10141 {
10142 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10143 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10144 }
10145
10146 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10147 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10148
10149 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10150 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10151 #endif
10152
10153 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10154
10155 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10156 fixup_locale ();
10157 xg_initialize ();
10158
10159 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10160
10161 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10162 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10163
10164 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10165 {
10166 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10167 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10168 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10169
10170 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10171 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10172 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name(s, Qnil);
10173
10174 if (! NILP (abs_file) && Ffile_readable_p (abs_file))
10175 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10176
10177 UNGCPRO;
10178 }
10179
10180 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10181 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10182 }
10183 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10184 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10185 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10186 errors with X11R5:
10187 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10188 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10189 So let's not use it until R6. */
10190 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10191 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10192 #endif
10193
10194 {
10195 int argc = 0;
10196 char *argv[3];
10197
10198 argv[0] = "";
10199 argc = 1;
10200 if (xrm_option)
10201 {
10202 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10203 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10204 }
10205 turn_on_atimers (0);
10206 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10207 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10208 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10209 &argc, argv);
10210 turn_on_atimers (1);
10211
10212 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10213 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10214 fixup_locale ();
10215 #endif
10216 }
10217
10218 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10219 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10220 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10221 #endif
10222 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10223 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10224 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10225
10226 /* Detect failure. */
10227 if (dpy == 0)
10228 {
10229 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10230 return 0;
10231 }
10232
10233 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10234
10235 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10236 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10237
10238 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10239 {
10240 struct x_display_info *share;
10241 Lisp_Object tail;
10242
10243 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10244 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10245 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10246 SDATA (display_name)))
10247 break;
10248 if (share)
10249 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10250 else
10251 {
10252 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10253 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10254 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10255 {
10256 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10257 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10258 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10259 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10260 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10261 BLOCK_INPUT;
10262 }
10263
10264 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10265 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10266 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10267 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10268 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10269 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10270 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10271 }
10272 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10273 }
10274 #endif
10275
10276 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10277 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10278 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10279
10280 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10281 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10282 x_display_name_list);
10283 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10284
10285 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10286
10287 #if 0
10288 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10289 #endif /* ! 0 */
10290
10291 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10292 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10293 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10294 + 2);
10295 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10296 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10297
10298 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10299 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10300
10301 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10302 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10303 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10304
10305 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10306 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10307 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10308 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10309 #else
10310 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10311 #endif
10312 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10313 all versions. */
10314 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10315
10316 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10317 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10318 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10319 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10320 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10321 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10322 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10323 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10324 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10325 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10326 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10327 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10328 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10329 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10330 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10331 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10332 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10335 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10336 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10337 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10338 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10339 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10340 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10341 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10343 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10344 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10345 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10346 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10347
10348 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10349 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10350 {
10351 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10352 {
10353 Lisp_Object value;
10354 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10355 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10356 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10357 Qnil, Qnil);
10358 if (STRINGP (value)
10359 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10360 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10361 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10362 }
10363 }
10364 else
10365 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10366 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10367
10368 {
10369 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10370 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10371 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10372 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10373 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10374 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10375 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10376 }
10377
10378 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10379 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10380 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10381 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10382 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10383 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10384 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10385 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10386 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10387 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10389 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10390 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10391 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10392 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10393 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10394 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10395 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10397 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10399 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10400 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10401 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10402 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10403 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10414 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10415 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10416 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10417 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10418 /* For properties of font. */
10419 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10423 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10424 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10425 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10426 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10427
10428 /* Ghostscript support. */
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10430 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10431
10432 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10433 False);
10434
10435 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10436
10437 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10438 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10439
10440 {
10441 char null_bits[1];
10442
10443 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10444
10445 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10446 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10447 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10448 1);
10449 }
10450
10451 {
10452 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10453 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10454 dpyinfo->gray
10455 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10456 gray_bitmap_bits,
10457 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10458 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10459 }
10460
10461 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10462 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10463 #endif
10464
10465 #ifdef subprocesses
10466 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10467 if (connection != 0)
10468 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10469 #endif
10470
10471 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10472 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10473 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10474 /* stdin is a socket here */
10475 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10476 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10477 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10478 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10479 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10480 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10481
10482 #ifdef SIGIO
10483 if (interrupt_input)
10484 init_sigio (connection);
10485 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10486
10487 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10488 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10489 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10490 so that Xt does not crash. */
10491 {
10492 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10493 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10494 Font font;
10495 int count;
10496
10497 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10498 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10499 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10500 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10501 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10502 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10503 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10504 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10505 abort ();
10506 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10507 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10508 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10509 }
10510 #endif
10511 #endif
10512
10513 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10514 for debugging X code. */
10515 {
10516 Lisp_Object value;
10517 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10518 build_string ("synchronous"),
10519 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10520 Qnil, Qnil);
10521 if (STRINGP (value)
10522 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10523 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10524 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10525 }
10526
10527 {
10528 Lisp_Object value;
10529 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10530 build_string ("useXIM"),
10531 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10532 Qnil, Qnil);
10533 #ifdef USE_XIM
10534 if (STRINGP (value)
10535 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10536 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10537 use_xim = 0;
10538 #else
10539 if (STRINGP (value)
10540 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10541 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10542 use_xim = 1;
10543 #endif
10544 }
10545
10546 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10547
10548 return dpyinfo;
10549 }
10550 \f
10551 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10552 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10553
10554 void
10555 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10556 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10557 {
10558 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10559
10560 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10561 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10562 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10563 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10564 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10565 else
10566 {
10567 Lisp_Object tail;
10568
10569 tail = x_display_name_list;
10570 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10571 {
10572 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10573 {
10574 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10575 break;
10576 }
10577 tail = XCDR (tail);
10578 }
10579 }
10580
10581 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10582 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10583
10584 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10585 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10586 else
10587 {
10588 struct x_display_info *tail;
10589
10590 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10591 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10592 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10593 }
10594
10595 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10596 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10597 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10598 #endif
10599 #endif
10600 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10601 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10602 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10603 #endif
10604 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10605 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10606 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10607 #endif
10608
10609 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10610 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10611 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10612 xfree (dpyinfo);
10613 }
10614
10615 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10616
10617 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10618 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10619 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10620 that slows us down. */
10621
10622 static void
10623 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10624 struct atimer *timer;
10625 {
10626 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10627 {
10628 BLOCK_INPUT;
10629 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10630 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10631 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10632 }
10633 }
10634
10635 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10636
10637 \f
10638 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10639
10640 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10641
10642 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10643 {
10644 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10645 x_produce_glyphs,
10646 x_write_glyphs,
10647 x_insert_glyphs,
10648 x_clear_end_of_line,
10649 x_scroll_run,
10650 x_after_update_window_line,
10651 x_update_window_begin,
10652 x_update_window_end,
10653 x_cursor_to,
10654 x_flush,
10655 #ifndef XFlush
10656 x_flush,
10657 #else
10658 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10659 #endif
10660 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10661 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10662 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10663 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10664 x_per_char_metric,
10665 x_encode_char,
10666 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10667 x_draw_glyph_string,
10668 x_define_frame_cursor,
10669 x_clear_frame_area,
10670 x_draw_window_cursor,
10671 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10672 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10673 };
10674
10675 void
10676 x_initialize ()
10677 {
10678 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10679
10680 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10681 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10682 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10683 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10684 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10685 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10686 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10687 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10688 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10689 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10690 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10691 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10692 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10693 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10694 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10695 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10696 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10697 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10698
10699 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10700 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10701 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10702 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10703 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10704 off the bottom */
10705 baud_rate = 19200;
10706
10707 x_noop_count = 0;
10708 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10709 any_help_event_p = 0;
10710
10711 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10712 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10713
10714 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10715 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10716
10717 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10718
10719 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10720 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10721 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10722 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10723 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10724 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10725 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10726
10727 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10728
10729 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10730 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10731 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10732 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10733 widgets don't behave normally. */
10734 {
10735 EMACS_TIME interval;
10736 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10737 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10738 }
10739 #endif
10740
10741 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10742 #ifndef USE_GTK
10743 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10744 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10745 #endif
10746 #endif
10747
10748 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10749 original error handler. */
10750 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10751 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10752
10753 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10754 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10755 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10756 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10757
10758 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10759
10760 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10761 x_session_initialize ();
10762 #endif
10763 }
10764
10765
10766 void
10767 syms_of_xterm ()
10768 {
10769 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10770 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10771
10772 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10773 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10774
10775 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10776 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10777
10778 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10779 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10780
10781 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10782 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10783 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10784 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10785
10786 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10787 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10788
10789 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10790 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10791 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10792 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10793 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10794 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10795 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10796
10797 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10798 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10799 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10800 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10801 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10802 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10803 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10804 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10805 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10806 #elif USE_GTK
10807 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10808 #else
10809 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10810 #endif
10811 #else
10812 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10813 #endif
10814
10815 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10816 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10817
10818 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10819 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10820 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10821 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10822 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10823 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10824 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10825 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10826 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10827
10828 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10829 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10830 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10831 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10832 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10833 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10834
10835 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10836 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10837 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10838 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10839 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10840 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10841
10842 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10843 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10844 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10845 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10846 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10847 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10848
10849 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10850 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10851 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10852 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10853 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10854 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10855
10856 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10857 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10858 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10859 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10860 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10861 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10862 }
10863
10864 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */